Toshiba Cell Phone VM4050 User Manual

User’s Guide  
PCS Vision Phone VM4050 by Toshiba  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adding a Word to the T9 Database . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27  
Entering Characters by Tapping the Keypad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28  
Entering Numbers, Symbols, and Smileys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29  
2B. Controlling Your Phone’s Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30  
Sound Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31  
Ringer Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31  
Selecting the Key Tone Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34  
Adjusting the Phone’s Volume Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35  
Alert Notification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36  
Silence All . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36  
Display Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37  
Changing the Text Greeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37  
Changing the Backlight Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37  
Changing the Screen Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40  
Changing the Sub Display Contrast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41  
Changing the Clock Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42  
Changing the Sub Display Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43  
Changing the Sub Display Direction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44  
Location Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44  
Airplane Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45  
TTY Use With PCS Service From Sprint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45  
Phone Setup Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47  
Setting Open to Answer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47  
Setting Any Key Answer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47  
Auto Answer Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48  
Changing the Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48  
Setting Speed Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48  
Setting Phone Book Match Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49  
Setting Abbreviated Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49  
Using the Voice Guidance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50  
Displaying Your Phone Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2C. Setting Your Phone’s Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52  
Accessing the Security Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53  
Locking Your Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53  
Unlocking Your Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53  
Locking on Power-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54  
Changing the Lock Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54  
Calling in Lock Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54  
Using Special Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55  
Erasing the Internal Phone Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55  
Erasing the Downloads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55  
Resetting Your Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56  
Resetting Your Picture Mail Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56  
2D. Controlling Your Roaming Experience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57  
Understanding Roaming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58  
Setting Your Phone’s Roam Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60  
Controlling Roaming Charges Using Call Guard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61  
2E. Navigating Through Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62  
Menu Navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63  
Menu Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63  
Viewing the Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65  
My Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68  
2F. Managing Call History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70  
Viewing History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71  
Call History Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71  
Making a Call From Call History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72  
Saving a Phone Number From Call History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72  
Prepending a Phone Number From Call History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73  
Erasing Call History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2G. Using the Internal Phone Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74  
Internal Phone Book Entry Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75  
Adding a New Internal Phone Book Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76  
Finding Internal Phone Book Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77  
Adding a Phone Number or Address to an Internal Phone Book Entry . .79  
Editing an Internal Phone Book Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80  
Assigning a Picture to an Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81  
Selecting a Ringer Type for a Phone Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82  
Secret Phone Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83  
Changing an Icon for a Phone Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84  
Changing the Order of Phone Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84  
Erasing Phone Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85  
Erasing Internal Phone Book Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85  
Dialing PCS Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86  
Phone Book Match Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86  
Prepending a Phone Number From the Internal Phone Book . . . . . . . . . .86  
Speed Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87  
Using the Group List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89  
2H. Personal Organizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92  
Adding an Event to the Scheduler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93  
Event Alarm Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94  
Event Alerts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94  
Viewing Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95  
Erasing a Day’s Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95  
Purging Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96  
Purging All Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96  
Using the Alarm Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97  
Using the Countdown Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98  
Using Your Phone’s Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99  
Using the Calculator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2I. Using Your Phone’s Voice Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100  
Using Voice-Activated Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101  
Recording a Voice Dial Tag to Your Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102  
Erasing All Voice Dial Tags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104  
Recording Voice Memos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105  
Playing Voice Memos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106  
Voice Memo Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106  
Erasing All Voice Memos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108  
2J. Using Your Phone’s Camera With Camcorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109  
Taking Pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110  
SM  
Creating Your Picture Mail Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112  
Camera Mode Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113  
Taking Videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116  
Camcorder Mode Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117  
SM  
Sharing Picture Mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118  
Sharing Picture Mail From My Pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118  
Sharing Picture Mail From Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121  
Sharing Video Mail From My Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122  
Sharing Video Mail From Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123  
Storing Pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124  
Viewing Pictures in Your Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124  
Uploading Pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126  
Viewing Downloaded Pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127  
Assigning Pictures to Phone Tasks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128  
Erasing Pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129  
Storing Videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130  
Viewing Videos in Your Camcorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130  
Uploading Videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132  
Viewing Downloaded Videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133  
Erasing Videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134  
Managing Picture Mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135  
Using the Picture Mail Website . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135  
Managing Online Picture Mail From Your PCS Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135  
Sharing Online Picture Mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136  
Accessing Online Picture Mail Options From Your PCS Phone . . . . . . .138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140  
3A. PCS Service Features: The Basics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141  
Using Voicemail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142  
Setting Up Your Voicemail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142  
Voicemail Notification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142  
New Voicemail Message Alerts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142  
Retrieving Your Voicemail Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143  
Voicemail Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144  
Clearing the Message Icon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146  
Voicemail Menu Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147  
Using Caller ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148  
Responding to Call Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148  
Making a Three-Way Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149  
Using Call Forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150  
SM  
3B. PCS Vision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151  
Getting Started With PCS Vision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152  
Your User Name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152  
Launching a PCS Vision Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153  
Net Guard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154  
PCS Vision Connection Status and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154  
Signing In and Out of PCS Vision Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155  
Updating Your Vision Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155  
Navigating the Web . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156  
SM  
Picture Mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158  
Taking Pictures and Videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158  
Sharing Picture/Video Mail From Your PCS Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158  
New Picture/Video Mail Message Notifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160  
Viewing Incoming Picture/Video Mail Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160  
Erasing Picture/Video Mail Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161  
Accessing the Picture Mail Website From Your Computer . . . . . . . . . . .162  
Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163  
Message Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163  
Accessing the Messaging Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Text Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164  
Sending a Text Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164  
New Message Notifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166  
Checking Incoming Text Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166  
Reviewing Outgoing Text Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168  
Erasing All Text Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170  
Setting Up for Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171  
Signing Up for Updates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172  
PCS Mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173  
Using PCS Mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173  
Accessing PCS Mail Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173  
Composing PCS Mail Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173  
PCS Short Mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174  
Using PCS Short Mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174  
Chat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176  
Downloading Premium Services Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177  
Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179  
Ringers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181  
Screen Savers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184  
Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187  
Web . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188  
Using the Browser Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189  
SM  
PCS Business Connection Personal Edition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193  
PCS Vision FAQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194  
SM  
3C. PCS Voice Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195  
Getting Started With PCS Voice Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196  
Creating Your Own Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196  
Making a Call With PCS Voice Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information . . .198  
4A. Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199  
Getting the Most Out of Your Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200  
Maintaining Safe Use of and Access to Your Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201  
Caring for the Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206  
Maintaining Safe Use of the Travel Charger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207  
Acknowledging Special Precautions and the FCC Notice . . . . . . . . . . . .209  
Emergency Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211  
Consumer Information on Wireless Phones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212  
Owner’s Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230  
User’s Guide Proprietary Notice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230  
End User License Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231  
4B. Manufacturer’s Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232  
Manufacturer’s Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233  
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Welcome to Sprint  
print built the largest all-digital, all-PCS nationwide network with  
S
advanced multimedia services, reaching more than 240 million  
people for clarity you can see and hear. We built our network to give  
you what we believe you really want from a wireless phone: clear  
sound, private conversations, and time-saving features.  
But with Sprint, you can do something even more far-reaching: simplify  
your life. Our advanced technology is designed to grow with your  
communications needs, so that one day you'll be able to rely entirely on  
your PCS Phone to stay connected.  
This guide will familiarize you with our technology and your new  
PCS Vision Phone through simple, easy-to-follow instructions. If you  
have already reviewed the Start Here Guide, which was packaged with  
your new phone, then you're ready to explore the advanced features  
outlined in this guide.  
If you have not read your Start Here Guide, go to Section One –  
Getting Started. This section provides all the information you need  
to unlock your phone, set up your voicemail, and much more. It also  
contains information on how to contact Sprint if you have any  
questions about your service, wish to check your account balance, or  
want to purchase additional products or services.  
Thank you for choosing Sprint.  
i
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
his User's Guide introduces you to PCS Service and all the features  
T
of your new phone. It’s divided into four sections:  
Section1: Getting Started  
Section2: Understanding Your Phone  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
Section4: Safety and Warranty Information  
Throughout the guide, you'll find tips that highlight special shortcuts  
and timely reminders to help you make the most of your new phone and  
service. The Table of Contents and Index will help you locate specific  
information quickly.  
You'll get the most out of your phone if you read each section. However,  
if you'd like to get right to a specific feature, simply turn to that page.  
Follow the instructions in that section, and you'll be ready to use your  
phone in no time.  
Tip: You can print this guide to keep on hand or to view it online. If you're viewing  
it online, simply click on a topic in the Table of Contents or Index or on any page  
reference. The PDF will automatically display the appropriate page.  
ii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1  
Getting Started  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1A  
Setting Up Service  
In This Section  
GettingStartedWithPCS Service  
SettingUpVoicemail  
GettingHelp  
his section walks you through unlocking your phone, setting up your  
Tvoicemail, and contacting Sprint for assistance with your PCS Service.  
Section 1: Getting Started  
1A: Setting Up Service  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting Started With PCS Service  
DetermineifYourPhoneisAlreadyActivated  
If you received your phone in the mail or purchased it at a  
Sprint Store, it probably has already been activated. All you need to  
do is unlock your phone.  
If your phone is not activated, please refer to the Start Here Guide  
included with your phone.  
UnlockingYourPhone  
Follow these steps to unlock your phone:  
END  
1. Press and hold  
to turn the phone on.  
MENU  
2. Press  
. (You will be prompted to enter your lock code, if  
your phone is locked.)  
3. Enter your four-digit lock code. For security purposes, the code  
is not visible as you type.  
Tip: If you can’t recall your lock code, try using the last four digits of either your  
Social Security number or PCS Phone Number or try 0000. If none of these work,  
call PCS Customer Solutions at 1-888-211-4PCS (4727).  
Section 1: Getting Started  
1A: Setting Up Service  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up Your Voicemail  
All unanswered calls to your PCS Phone are automatically transferred  
to voicemail, even if your phone is in use or turned off. Therefore,  
you will want to set up your voicemail and personal greeting as soon  
as your PCS Phone is activated.  
To set up voicemail:  
1
1. Press and hold  
.
2. Follow the system prompts to create your pass code, record  
your greeting, record your name announcement, and choose  
whether to activate One-Touch Message Access (a feature that  
1
lets you access messages simply by pressing and holding  
bypassing the need for you to enter your pass code).  
,
Note: The voicemail setup process may vary in certain Affiliate areas.  
For more information about using your voicemail, see  
“Using Voicemail” on page 142.  
Getting Help  
VisitOurWebsite  
Stop by www.sprintpcs.com and sign on to get up-to-date information  
on PCS Services, options and more.  
You can also:  
Review coverage maps  
Learn how to use voicemail  
Access your account information  
Purchase accessories  
Add additional options to your service plan  
Check out frequently asked questions  
And more  
Section 1: Getting Started  
1A: Setting Up Service  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ReachingPCSCustomerSolutions  
You can reach PCS Customer Solutions by:  
TALK  
2
Dialing  
on your PCS Phone  
Calling us toll-free at 1-888-211-4727 (Consumer customers),  
1-877-CLEARPY (253-2779) (Clear Pay customers), or  
1-888-788-4727 (Business customers)  
Writing to us at PCS Customer Solutions, P.O. Box 8077,  
London, KY 40742  
ReceivingAutomatedInvoicingInformation  
For your convenience, your phone gives you access to invoicing  
information on your PCS Account. This information includes  
balance due, payment received, invoicing cycle, and the number of  
minutes used since your last invoicing cycle. (Normal airtime usage  
will apply.)  
To access this information:  
TALK  
4
Press  
.
Note: This service may not be available in all Affiliate markets.  
PCSDirectoryAssistance  
PCS Directory Assistance provides a variety of services, including  
residential, business, and government listings; assistance with local  
or long-distance calls; movie listings; hotel, restaurant, shopping, and  
major local event information. There is a per-call charge and you will  
be billed for airtime.  
TALK  
4
1
1
Press  
.
PCSOperatorServices  
PCS Operator Services can provide assistance in placing collect calls  
or calls billed to a local telephone calling card or third party.  
TALK  
0
Press  
.
For more information or to see the latest in products and services,  
Note: PCS Operator Services may not be available in all Affiliate markets.  
Section 1: Getting Started  
1A: Setting Up Service  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2  
Understanding Your  
PCS Phone  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2A  
Your PCS Phone: The Basics  
In This Section  
FrontViewofPhone  
ViewingtheDisplayScreen  
FeaturesofYourPhone  
TurningYour PhoneOnandOff  
UsingtheBatteryandCharger  
DisplayingYourPhoneNumber  
MakingandAnsweringCalls  
EnteringText  
our PCS Phone is packed with features that simplify your life and  
Yexpand your ability to stay connected to the people and  
information that are important to you. This section will guide you  
through the basic functions and calling features of your phone.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Front View of Phone  
1. LED (green/red)  
2. Camera  
5. Main  
Display  
Lens  
3. Flash  
12. MENU  
6. Left  
Softkey  
13. Right  
Softkey  
7. Navigation  
Key  
14. Headset  
Jack  
8. TALK  
9. Volume  
Keys  
15. END  
(Power)  
10. Side  
Camera  
Key  
16. OK  
17. Camera /  
Video Key  
11. Speaker-  
phone Key  
18. BACK  
4. Sub Display  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Key Functions  
1. LED(green/red)blinks green for incoming calls; blinks red for  
notifications (messages, voicemail, and alerts).  
2. CameraLenslets you take pictures with auto focus function.  
3. Flashimproves picture quality in low-light conditions.  
4. SubDisplay(LCD)lets you monitor the phone’s status.  
5. MainDisplay(LCD)shows the phone’s menus and various features.  
6. LeftSoftkeyallows you to select an action or item at the bottom  
left of the main display.  
7. NavigationKeyscrollsthroughmenusanddisplaysthenextor  
previousmenuoption. AlsoactsasashortcutkeyforWeb( ), Find  
NameinPhoneBook( ), MyMenu( ), andDownloads( ).  
8. TALKallows you to place or to answer a call.  
9. VolumeKeysadjust the volume during a call or mute the ringer of  
an incoming call.  
10. SideCameraKeyactivates Camera mode and takes a picture.  
11. SpeakerphoneKeyactivates Speakerphone mode.  
12. MENUaccesses the phone’s main menu.  
13. RightSoftkeyallows you to select an action or item at the bottom  
right of the main display.  
14. HeadsetJackallows you to plug in an optional headset for  
hands-free use.  
15. END(Power)allows you to power the phone on or off, to end  
calls, or to return to standby mode from any screen.  
16. OKallows you to select highlighted menu items and to confirm  
actions.  
17. Camera/VideoKeyaccesses the Pictures/Video menu and allows  
you to take a picture or a video.  
18. BACKallows you to clear an entry or to back up within a menu.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Viewing the Display Screen  
Thislistidentifiesthesymbolsyou’llseeonyourdisplayscreen.  
shows your current signal strength. The more lines you have,  
the stronger your signal.  
means your phone cannot find a signal.  
tells you a call is in progress.  
indicates you are “roaming” off the enhanced  
Sprint Nationwide PCS Network. (If you are roaming on an analog  
system, your phone’s display will show the roaming icon and an  
“Analog Roam” text alert.)  
indicates you have new text/picture messages.  
indicates you have voicemail messages. Press and  
1
hold  
to call your voicemail box.  
indicates you have new text/picture and voicemail messages.  
indicates your PCS Vision connection is active.  
indicates your PCS Vision connection is dormant.  
indicates the phone is not currently able to access PCS Vision  
service features.  
indicates the Location feature is enabled.  
indicates the Location feature is disabled.  
indicates the Web browser is in secure mode.  
indicates Speakerphone mode is active.  
indicates Vibrating Alert is active.  
indicates TTY mode is active.  
shows the level of your battery charge.  
indicates your phone is in Airplane Mode.  
These additional icons will be displayed in standby mode.  
indicates the ringer volume is set to off.  
indicates your phone is locked.  
indicates Countdown Timer is active.  
indicates Alarm Clock is active.  
indicates Event Alarm is active.  
indicates Auto Answer is active.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features of Your PCS Vision Phone  
VM4050 by Toshiba  
Congratulations on the purchase of your PCS Vision Phone VM4050  
by Toshiba. This phone is lightweight, easy-to-use, and reliable. It also  
offers many significant features and service options:  
Dual-band capability provides access to other PCS Digital and  
Analog Networks where Sprint has implemented roaming  
agreements (page 57).  
SM  
PCS Vision provides access to the wireless Internet in digital  
mode (page 188).  
PCS Mail and PCS Short Mail provide quick and convenient text  
messaging capabilities (page 173).  
SM  
PCS Voice Command lets you dial phone numbers by speaking  
someone’s name or the digits in their phone number (page 195).  
Downloadable games, ringers, screen savers, and more allow you  
to turn down time into fun time and to personalize your phone  
(page 177).  
The built-in scheduler lets you schedule alerts to remind you of  
important events (page 93).  
Three hundred internal Phone Book entries store up to five  
phone numbers, three email addresses, and one URL each  
(page 74).  
Speed Dialing lets you call the phone number stored in the  
internal Phone Book with one or two key presses.  
The built-in camera with camcorder allows you to take full-color  
digital pictures and video, view your pictures and video using the  
phone’s display, and instantly share them with family and friends  
SM  
using Picture Mail service (page 109).  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turning Your Phone ON and OFF  
TurningYourPhoneOn  
END  
Press  
for approximately two seconds to turn your  
phone on.  
Once your phone is on, it displays “Looking for Service” which  
indicates that your phone is searching for a signal. When your phone  
finds a signal, it automatically enters standby mode – the phone’s idle  
state. At this point, you are ready to begin making and receiving calls.  
If your phone is unable to find a signal after 15 minutes of searching, a  
Power Save feature is automatically activated. When a signal is found,  
your phone automatically returns to standby mode.  
In Power Save mode, your phone searches for a signal periodically  
without your intervention. You can also initiate a search for  
PCS Service by pressing any key (when your phone is turned on).  
Tip: The Power Save feature helps to conserve your battery power when you are  
in an area where there is no signal.  
TurningYourPhoneOff  
END  
Press  
for two seconds until you see the powering down  
animation on the display screen.  
Your screen remains blank while your phone is off (unless the battery  
is charging).  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Your Phone’s Battery  
BatteryCapacity  
Your PCS Phone is equipped with a Lithium Ion (LiIon) battery.  
It allows you to recharge your battery before it is fully drained.  
The standard battery provides approximately 3.3 hours of  
continuous digital talk time (1.5 hours in analog) or approximately  
360 hours of continuous digital standby time (18 hours in analog).  
The extended battery provides approximately 5.4 hours of  
continuous digital talk time (2.4 hours in analog) or approximately  
580 hours of continuous digital standby time (29 hours in analog).  
When the battery charge is getting too low, the battery icon blinks.  
When there are approximately five minutes of talk time left, the  
phone sounds an audible alert and then powers down.  
Note: Long backlight settings, searching for service, camera/camcorder mode,  
vibrate mode, and browser use affect the battery’s talk and standby times.  
Tip: Be sure to watch your phone’s battery level indicator and charge the battery  
before it runs out of power.  
InstallingtheBattery  
Your PCS Phone comes with a LiIon battery.  
Follow these steps to install it:  
1. Press and hold the latch on the phone  
and slide the battery cover to remove it.  
2. Insert the bottom of the battery pack  
into the phone and place it down.  
3. Place the battery cover on the phone and  
slide it until the latch snaps into place.  
Note: Make sure the cover is securely attached to the phone. The battery pack  
may separate from the phone if the cover is not properly attached.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
RemovingtheBattery  
To remove your battery, follow these easy steps:  
1. Make sure the power is off so that you don’t lose any stored  
numbers or messages.  
2. Press and hold the latch on the phone  
and slide the battery cover to remove it.  
3. To remove the battery pack, lift up  
using the tab at the top of the battery.  
Tip:Whenusingtheextendedbattery(soldseparately), usethesuppliedbatterycover.  
ChargingtheBattery  
Your PCS Phone comes with a rechargeable battery. You should  
charge the battery as soon as possible so you can begin using  
your phone.  
Keeping track of your battery’s charge is important. If your battery  
level becomes too low, your phone automatically turns off and you  
will lose all the information you were just working on. For a quick  
check of your phone’s battery level, glance at the battery charge  
indicator located in the upper-right corner of your phone’s display  
screen. If the battery charge is getting too low, the battery icon (  
blinks and the phone sounds a warning tone.  
)
Always use a Sprint-approved desktop charger, travel charger, or  
vehicle power adapter to charge your battery.  
Warning! Using the wrong battery charger could cause damage to your phone  
and void the warranty.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UsingtheTravelCharger  
To use the travel charger provided with your phone:  
1. Plug the round end of the travel charger into the bottom of the  
phone with battery installed.  
2. Plug the travel charger into the electrical outlet (AC120V).  
The LED indicator lights red while the battery is charging.  
The LED indicator turns green when charging is complete.  
It takes approximately 2.5 hours for the standard battery and 3.5 hours  
for the extended battery to fully recharge when completely drained.  
With the Sprint-approved LiIon battery, you can recharge the battery  
before it becomes completely run down.  
Note: For complete charging, it is recommended that the phone be kept off  
during charging.  
Note: It is normal for the battery to become warmer during charging.  
AC120V  
Travel Charger  
UsingtheTravelChargerandDesktopHolder  
A combination of the travel charger and the desktop holder (sold  
separately) provides a convenient way to charge the phone’s battery  
as illustrated below.  
AC120V  
Travel Charger  
Desktop Holder  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displaying Your Phone Number  
Just in case you forget your phone number, your PCS Phone can  
remind you.  
To display your phone number:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
3. Highlight Information and press  
4. Highlight PhoneInfo andpress  
.
OK  
.
OK  
. Yourphonenumberand  
otherinformationaboutyourphoneandaccountwillbedisplayed.  
MENU  
Note: Toaccessthephone’smainmenu, press  
fromstandbymode. Menu  
itemsmaybeselectedbyhighlightingthemwiththenavigationkeyandpressing  
OK  
, oryoucanpressthenumbercorrespondingtothemenuitemonyourkeypad.  
Making and Answering Calls  
Making Calls  
Your PCS Phone offers many different ways to make calls, including  
SM  
PCS Voice Command (page 195), Speed Dialing (page 87), and using  
Call History (page 70).  
To make a call using your keypad:  
1. Make sure your phone is on.  
2. Enter a phone number. (If you make a mistake while dialing,  
BACK  
BACK  
press  
to erase one digit at a time. Press and hold  
to  
erase the entire number.)  
TALK  
3. Press  
. (To make a call when you are roaming and  
TALK  
1
Call Guard is enabled, press  
and press  
when prompted.  
See “Call Guard” on page 61.)  
END  
4. Press  
or close the phone when you are finished.  
TALK  
Tip: To redial your last outgoing call, press  
twice.  
Tip: When making calls off the enhanced Sprint Nationwide PCS Network,  
always dial using 11 digits (1 + area code + phone number).  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Answering Calls  
To answer an incoming call:  
1. Make sure your phone is on. (If your phone is off, incoming calls  
go to voicemail.)  
TALK  
2. When your phone rings or vibrates, press  
to answer the  
incoming call.(Depending on your phone’s settings, you may  
also answer incoming calls by opening the phone or by pressing  
any digit key.)  
Your PCS Phone notifies you of incoming calls in the following ways:  
The phone rings or vibrates.  
The LED flashes green.  
The backlight illuminates.  
The screen displays an incoming call message.  
If available, the phone number of the caller is displayed.  
If the phone number is in your internal Phone Book, the Phone  
Book entry’s name is displayed.  
END  
Tip: To mute the ringer or stop the vibrating, press  
keys on the side of your phone.  
or press any of three  
Tip: To answer the call using the speakerphone mode, press  
.
AnsweringaRoamCallWithCallGuardEnabled  
To answer a call when you are roaming and Call Guard is enabled:  
TALK  
1
Press  
and press  
to answer the call. (See “Call Guard”  
on page 61 for additional information.)  
Note: If your phone is off, incoming calls go to voicemail.  
EndingaCall  
To disconnect a call when you are finished:  
END  
Close the phone or press  
.
Note: When you use the phone with an earphone-microphone or TTY device, you  
can continue a call even if the phone is closed.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Missed Call Notification  
When an incoming call is not answered, your phone displays the  
Missed Call notification. You can view the number of missed calls and  
the last caller’s name on the screen.  
To dial the last missed call:  
TALK  
Press  
.
To display the list of missed calls:  
OK  
Press  
press  
. (To dial the phone number, highlight the entry and  
.)  
TALK  
Calling Emergency Numbers  
TALK  
9
1
1
You can place calls to 911 (dial  
and press  
), even  
if your phone is locked or your account is restricted.  
LocatingPositioninEmergencyCalls(GPS)  
Your phone supports the system to locate your position when you  
make an emergency call to “911”, “ 911”, or “#911” in digital mode.  
*
This feature is system dependent. The emergency call is momentarily  
interrupted, while the phone receives the GPS (Global Positioning  
System) signals.  
Important: See “Emergency Calls” on page 211.  
EmergencyCallMode  
When the emergency number “911”, “ 911”, or “#911” is dialed, the  
*
phone enters Emergency Call Mode and will attempt to complete the  
emergency call using any available cellular system it can find.  
After the call is ended, the phone will enter the Emergency Callback  
Mode and attempt to continue to receive service from the cellular  
system used to complete the call. “Emergency Callback Mode” will  
display.  
To exit from the Emergency mode, follow these instructions:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to display options.  
OK  
2. Highlight ExitEmergency and press  
.
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dialing Options  
Dialing options are displayed when you select Options (right softkey)  
after entering numbers in the phone’s standby mode.  
OK  
To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
Call to dial the phone number. (If you are roaming and have the  
Call Guard feature activated, you need to take an extra step. See  
“Call Guard” on page 61.)  
SavePhone# to save the phone number in your internal Phone  
Book. (See “Saving a Phone Number” on page 22.)  
HardPause to insert a hard pause “P”. (See “Dialing and Saving  
Phone Numbers With Pauses” on page 23.)  
2Sec. Pause to insert a 2-second pause “T”. (See “Dialing and  
Saving Phone Numbers With Pauses” on page 23.)  
Tip: To speed dial a phone number from standby mode, press and hold the speed  
dial number. If the speed dial number is two digits, enter the first digit, then press  
and hold the second digit. (This feature will not work when you are roaming and  
Call Guard is enabled.)  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In-Call Options  
MENU  
During a call, menu options are displayed when you press  
.
OK  
To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
3-WayCall to call a third party.  
Mute to mute the phone’s microphone. (Unmute to reactivate the  
microphone.)  
EndCall to end the call.  
CallHistory to display your phone’s Call History menu.  
PhoneBook to display your phone’s Phone Book menu.  
Settings to display your phone’s Settings menu.  
Information to display your phone’s Information menu.  
AdjustingtheEarpieceVolume  
Press the volume keys on the side of your phone during the call.  
MutingtheMicrophone  
To mute the microphone during a call:  
MENU  
OK  
Press  
, highlight Mute, and press  
.
To reactivate the microphone:  
MENU  
OK  
Press  
, highlight Unmute, and press  
.
UsingtheSpeakerphoneMode  
To activate the speakerphone mode during a call:  
Press  
.
To deactivate the speakerphone mode:  
Press  
again.  
UsingtheVoiceMemo  
To record your party’s voice during a call:  
1. Press and hold VoiceMemo (left softkey). (The Record screen  
appears.)  
OK  
2. Select Start (left softkey) or press  
.
3. Start recording after the beep.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UsingtheScratchPad  
You can enter a phone number during a call and save it to the Scratch  
Pad memory, so you may dial the number after the call. The Scratch  
Pad saves the last three numbers.  
To save the phone number to the Scratch Pad:  
1. Enter a phone number during a call.  
2. Select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
3. Highlight ScratchPad and press  
to save.  
To dial the number from the Scratch Pad:  
MENU  
1. From standby mode, press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight CallHistory and press  
3. Highlight ScratchPad and press  
.
OK  
.
TALK  
4. Select the number you want to dial and press  
.
Tip: You can also save or prepend a number from Scratch Pad. Just display a  
Scratch Pad number and press Options (right softkey) to display options.  
End-of-Call Options  
After receiving a call from or making a call, the phone number and  
the duration of the call are displayed.  
TALK  
Press  
to call again the number while it is displayed.  
SelectView (left softkey) to display the internal Phone Book entry  
that contains the number (if applicable).  
Note: The End-of-Call options are not available for calls identified as  
No ID or Restricted.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Saving a Phone Number  
Your PCS Phone can store up to five phone numbers in each of 300  
internal Phone Book entries. Each entry’s name can contain 36  
characters. Your phone automatically sorts the internal Phone Book  
entries alphabetically.  
To save a number from standby mode:  
1. Enter a phone number.  
2. Select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
3. Highlight SavePhone# and press  
.
OK  
Shortcut: From standby mode, enter a phone number and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight NewEntry and press  
.
5. Select an icon for the number from the options (  
Home,  
.
OK  
Work,  
Mobile, and more) and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight the  
icon to enter a name and press  
OK  
7. Enter a name for the entry and press  
.
8. Select Save (left softkey) to save the new entry.  
Tip: You can also save a number to an existing entry by selecting AddtoContact  
on step 4 above.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Finding a Phone Number  
You can search internal Phone Book entries for phone numbers.  
To find a phone number:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight FindName and press  
. (Your internal Phone Book  
list appears.)  
4. Press the navigation key left or right to scroll through pages or  
enter the first letters of a name to find the entry.  
OK  
5. Highlight the entry and press  
to display phone numbers.  
TALK  
6. To dial a phone number, highlight it and press  
.
Dialing and Saving Phone Numbers With Pauses  
You can dial or save phone numbers with pauses for use with  
automated systems, such as voicemail or credit card billing numbers.  
If you select a hard pause, the next set of numbers are sent when you  
TALK  
press  
. If you select a 2-second pause, your phone automatically  
sends the next set of numbers after two seconds.  
Note: You can have multiple pauses in a phone number and combine  
2-second and hard pauses.  
To dial or save phone numbers with pauses:  
1. Enter the phone number from standby mode.  
2. Select Options (right softkey) and highlight either HardPause or  
OK  
2Sec. Pauseand press  
. Hard pauses are displayed as a “P”  
and 2-second pauses as a “T”.  
3. Enter additional numbers.  
TALK  
OK  
4. Press  
to dial the number or press  
to save the number  
in your internal Phone Book.  
When dialing a number with a hard pause, select SendTone (left  
TALK  
softkey) or press  
to send the next set of numbers.  
Note: You can save up to 80 digits for phone numbers with pauses.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dialing From the Internal Phone Book  
To dial directly from an internal Phone Book entry:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
3. Highlight FindName and press  
4. Highlight the entry and press  
.
OK  
.
OK  
.
TALK  
TALK  
5. Highlight the phone number and press  
.
OK  
Tip: To dial the first phone number in the entry, press  
step 4 above.  
instead of  
in  
Using One-Touch/Two-Touch Speed Dialing  
When this feature is activated, you can dial Speed Dial entries by using  
one key press for locations 2-9 or two key presses for locations 10-99.  
(See “Setting Speed Dialing” on page 48 and “Assigning a Speed Dial  
Location” on page 87.)  
To use One-TouchDialing for Speed Dial locations 2-9:  
Pressandholdtheappropriatekeyforapproximatelyonesecond.  
The display confirms that the number has been dialed when it  
shows “Calling...”.  
To use Two-TouchDialing for Speed Dial locations 10-99:  
1. Press the first digit.  
2. Press and hold the second digit for approximately one second.  
The display confirms that the number has been dialed when it  
shows “Calling...”.  
Note: Speed dialing is not available when you are roaming with  
Call Guard enabled.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Abbreviated Dialing  
If you often dial a group of phone numbers that has the same area  
code and same prefix, just save them once and activate Abbreviated  
Dialing. You will be able to dial a phone number by only entering the  
last four (or five) digits. To set up this feature, see “Setting  
Abbreviated Dialing” on page 49.  
To make a call with Abbreviated Dialing:  
1. Enter the last four (or five) digits from standby mode.  
TALK  
2. Press  
to dial. (If a Phonebook Match list appears, highlight  
TALK  
Abbrev. Dial and press  
.)  
Note: To make a call by entering last four digits, the first six digits should be preset.  
(To make a call by entering last five digits, the first five digits should be preset.)  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entering Text  
Selecting a Character Input Mode  
Your PCS Phone provides convenient ways to enter words, letters,  
punctuation, and numbers whenever you are prompted to enter text  
(for example, when adding an internal Phone Book entry or  
composing a text message).  
The current entry mode is displayed at the bottom of your screen: T9  
(T9 mode), abc (abc mode), or 123 (number mode).  
To change the character input mode:  
1. When you display a screen where you can enter text, press  
Options (left softkey).  
OK  
2. Select a character input mode and press  
.
T9 to enter characters using T9 Text Input  
(see page 27).  
abc to enter characters by tapping the keypad  
(see page 28).  
Number to enter numbers (see page 29).  
Symbols to enter symbols (see page 29).  
Smileys to enter “emoticons” (see page 29).  
There are several shortcuts available:  
To switch the mode between T9 and abc, press and hold Options  
(left softkey).  
#
To change to the Number mode, press and hold  
To change to the Symbols mode, press and hold  
.
.
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entering Characters Using T9 Text Input  
T9 Text Input lets you enter text in your PCS Phone by pressing keys  
just once per letter. (To select the T9mode when entering text, see  
“Selecting a Character Input Mode” on page 26.)  
T9 Text Input analyzes the letters you enter using an intuitive word  
database and creates a suitable word. (The word may change as you  
type.) If the word you want does not display after you have entered all  
0Next  
the letters, press  
to scroll through additional word selections.  
#
Space  
To accept a word and insert a space, press  
.
BACK  
If you make a mistake, press  
and hold  
to erase a single character. Press  
BACK  
to delete an entire entry when the cursor is at the end  
of the text.  
Shift  
To change the letter case, press  
. It appears as  
(normal),  
(initial cap.), or  
(caps. lock).  
1
To insert punctuation, press  
.
To enter digits, press and hold the digit key.  
Adding a Word to the T9 Database  
If a word you want to enter does not display as an option when you  
are using T9 Text Input, you can add it to the database.  
To add a word to the T9 Text Input database:  
1. Select the abc character input mode. (See “Selecting a Character  
Input Mode” on page 26.)  
2. Enter the word using multi-tap text entry. (See “Entering  
Characters by Tapping the Keypad” on page 28.) The word will  
appear as an option the next time you scroll through options  
during T9 Text Input.  
For more information about T9 Text Input, visit the Tegic Website at  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entering Characters by Tapping the Keypad  
To enter characters by tapping the keypad, select the abc mode (see  
“Selecting a Character Input Mode” on page26).  
Press the corresponding key until the desired character appears.  
Shift  
To change the letter case, press  
(initial cap.), or  
. It appears as  
(normal),  
(caps. lock).  
To enter digits, press and hold the digit key.  
Characters scroll in the following order:  
1
. @ ? 1 ! - , & : ' /  
2
A B C 2  
3
D E F 3  
4
G H I 4  
5
J K L 5  
6
M N O 6  
7
P Q R S 7  
8
T U V 8  
9
W X Y Z 9  
0Next  
0
#
Space  
Shift  
Space  
Shift  
After a character is entered, the cursor automatically advances to the  
next space after one second or when you enter a character on a  
different key.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entering Numbers, Symbols, and Smileys  
EnteringNumbers  
To enter numbers:  
1. Select Options (left softkey).  
OK  
2. Highlight Number and press  
.
3. Press digit keys to enter numbers.  
EnteringSymbols  
To enter a symbol by selecting from options:  
1. Select Options (left softkey).  
OK  
2. Highlight Symbols and press  
.
3. Highlight your desired symbol by using the navigation key and  
OK  
press  
. (You will return to the previous mode.)  
OK  
Tip: Highlight the  
icon and press  
to switch to the Smileys mode.  
EnteringSmileys  
To enter an “emoticon” by selecting from options:  
1. Select Options (left softkey).  
OK  
2. Highlight Smileys and press  
.
3. Highlight your desired emoticon by using the navigation key  
OK  
and press  
. (You will return to the previous mode.)  
OK  
Tip: Highlight the  
icon and press  
to switch to the Symbols mode.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2A:Your PCS Phone The Basics  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2B  
Controlling Your Phone’s Settings  
In This Section  
SoundSettings  
DisplaySettings  
LocationSettings  
AirplaneMode  
TTYAccess  
PhoneSetupOptions  
his section describes how you can change your phone’s settings to  
Tbest suit your needs. Take a few moments to review these options  
and add or adjust the settings that are right for you.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MENU  
Reminder: To access the phone’s main menu, press  
from standby mode.  
Menu items may be selected by highlighting them with the navigation key and  
OK  
pressing  
, or you can press the number corresponding to the menu item on  
your keypad.  
Sound Settings  
Ringer Types  
Ringer types help you identify incoming calls and messages. You can  
assign ringer types to individual phone book entries, types of calls,  
and types of messages (voicemail and text/picture messages).  
PreprogrammedRingers include a variety of standard ringer types  
and familiar music.  
VibratingRinger alerts you to calls or messages without  
disturbing others.  
DownloadedRingerscan be downloaded right to your phone.  
(See “Downloading Premium Services Content” on  
page 177 and “Ringers” on page 181.)  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SelectingRingerTypesforVoiceCalls  
Your PCS Phone provides a variety of ringer options which allow you  
to customize your ring and volume settings.  
To select a ringer type for voice calls so you recognize when a certain  
type of call is coming in by the ringer:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Sounds and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight RingerType and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight VoiceCalls and press  
.
6. Highlight WithCallerID, Restricted, NoCallerID, or Roaming and  
OK  
press  
.
OK  
7. Highlight one of the categories listed below, and press  
.
Pattern1 includes 9 ringer tones.  
Pattern2 includes 9 alarm tones.  
Melody includes 9 melodies.  
Downloads includes downloaded ringers.  
VoiceMemo includes sounds you have recorded in standby  
mode.  
OK  
8. Highlight your desired ringer type and press  
.
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SelectingaRingerTypeforVoicemailMessages  
To select a ringer type for voicemail message alerts:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Sounds and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight RingerType and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight Voicemail and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight one of the categories listed below, and press  
.
Pattern1 includes 9 ringer tones.  
Pattern2 includes 9 alarm tones.  
Melody includes 9 melodies.  
Downloads includes downloaded ringers.  
VoiceMemo includes sounds you have recorded in standby  
mode.  
Vibrate sets the vibrating alert.  
Off sets no ringer.  
OK  
7. Highlight your desired ringer type and press  
.
Tip: To select the duration of the message alert, see “Alert Notification” on page 36.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SelectingaRingerTypeforText/PictureMessages  
To select a ringer type for text/picture message alerts:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Sounds and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight RingerType and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight TextMsg./Pic. Mail and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight one of the categories listed below, and press  
.
Pattern1 includes 9 ringer tones.  
Pattern2 includes 9 alarm tones.  
Melody includes 9 melodies.  
Downloads includes downloaded ringers.  
VoiceMemo includes sounds you have recorded in standby  
mode.  
Vibrate sets the vibrating alert.  
Off sets no ringer.  
OK  
7. Highlight your desired ringer type and press  
.
Tip: To select the duration of the message alert, see “Alert Notification” on page 36.  
Selecting the Key Tone Length  
Your phone allows you to select the length of audible tones  
accompanying a key press. Longer tone length may be better for tone  
recognition when dialing voicemail or other automated systems.  
To select the key tone length:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Sounds and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight KeyToneLength and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight Short or Long and press  
.
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adjusting the Phone’s Volume Settings  
To adjust the ringer, key beep, and power on/off tone volume:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
3. Highlight Sounds and press  
4. Highlight Volume and press  
.
OK  
OK  
.
.
5. Highlight RingerVolume, KeyVolume, or PowerOn/Off and  
OK  
press  
.
RingerVolume toadjusttheringertonevolumeforvoicecalls,  
voicemail message alerts, and text/picture message alerts.  
KeyVolume toadjust the key beep tone volume.  
PowerOn/Off toadjust the power-on/power-off tone volume.  
OK  
6. Adjust the volume with the navigation key and press  
.
Level5+Vib to set the maximum ringer volume with the  
vibrating alert (only appears in the Ringer Volume setting).  
Level1-5 to set the volume level (1 to 5).  
Vib to switch the ringer to the vibrating alert (only appears  
in the Ringer Volume setting).  
Off to set the tones to off.  
SilenceAll to mute all tones from your phone (only appears  
in the Ringer Volume setting). See “Silence All” on page 36.  
Note: The Vib or Level 5+Vib option will also be applied to the Scheduler, Alarm  
Clock, and Countdown Timer alarms.  
To adjust the earpiece and speakerphone volume:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
3. Highlight Sounds and press  
4. Highlight Volume and press  
.
OK  
OK  
.
.
OK  
5. Highlight EarpieceVolume or SpeakerPhone and press  
.
OK  
6. Adjust the volume with the navigation key and press  
.
Tip: You can adjust the ringer volume in standby mode (or the earpiece volume  
during a call) by using the volume keys on the side of your phone.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Alert Notification  
Your phone comes with several different options to keep you aware  
of what's going on by sounding the alert or ringer.  
To set the alerts:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
3. Highlight Sounds and press  
4. Highlight Alerts and press  
.
OK  
.
OK  
.
OK  
5. Highlight the alert you want to change and press  
.
Service sets the alert to notify you when the network services  
OK  
parameter changes. Highlight On or Off and press  
.
Voicemail sets the duration of the voicemail message alerts.  
Highlight Once, 3Sec., 5Sec., 10Sec., 15Sec., or 30Sec. and  
OK  
press  
. (To set the alert off, see “Selecting a Ringer  
Type for Voicemail Messages” on page 33.)  
TextMsg./Pic. Mail sets the duration of the text/picture  
message alerts. Highlight Once, 3Sec., 5Sec., 10Sec., 15Sec.,  
OK  
or 30Sec. and press  
. (To set the alert off, see “Selecting  
a Ringer Type for Text/Picture Messages” on page 34.)  
MinuteBeep sets a minute reminder that beeps each minute  
OK  
during a call. Highlight On or Off and press  
.
CallLost sets an alert to notify you when your phone loses a  
OK  
signal during a call. Highlight On or Off and press  
.
Silence All  
There may be times when you need to silence your phone entirely.  
The phone’s Silence All option allows you to mute all sounds without  
turning your phone off. This function also disables the vibrating alert.  
To activate Silence All:  
Press and hold the volume key down in standby mode. (The  
screen will display “Silence All.”)  
To deactivate Silence All:  
Press the volume key up and select a desired volume level.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Display Settings  
Changing the Text Greeting  
The text greeting can be up to twelve characters and is displayed on  
your phone’s screen in standby mode.  
To display or change your custom greeting:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Display and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Greeting and press  
.
BACK  
5. Press and hold  
to erase the current greeting.  
OK  
6. Enter a new greeting and press  
. (See “Entering Text” on  
page 26.)  
Changing the Backlight Settings  
The backlight setting lets you select how long the display screen and  
keypad are backlit after any key press is made.  
To change the main LCD or sub LCD backlight setting for the standby  
mode:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
3. Highlight Display and press  
4. Highlight Backlight and press  
.
OK  
.
OK  
.
OK  
5. Highlight MainLCD or SubLCD and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight the desired option and press  
.
**Sec. turnsthedisplaybacklightonforaspecifiedduration(**).  
Tochangetheduration, highlightit, selectEdit (rightsoftkey),  
OK  
enteranewduration(5to30seconds)andpress  
.
FlipOpen keeps the display backlight on, while the phone is  
open. (Only appears in Main LCD backlight setting.)  
AlwaysOff keeps the display backlight off. (Only appears in  
Sub LCD backlight setting.)  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To change the main LCD backlight setting during a call:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
3. Highlight Display and press  
4. Highlight Backlight and press  
.
OK  
.
OK  
.
OK  
5. Highlight InUse and press  
.
OK  
6. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
Normal operates the same as the Main LCD backlight setting  
(Standby).  
AlwaysOn keeps the display backlight on until you finish  
the call.  
To change the keypad backlight setting:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
3. Highlight Display and press  
4. Highlight Backlight and press  
5. Highlight Keypad and press  
.
OK  
OK  
.
OK  
.
.
OK  
6. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
**Sec. turnsthekeypadbacklightonforaspecifiedduration(**).  
Tochangetheduration, highlightit, selectEdit (rightsoftkey),  
OK  
enteranewduration(5to30seconds)thenpress  
.
FlipOpen keeps the keypad backlight on, while the phone  
is open.  
AlwaysOff keeps the keypad backlight off.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To set the backlight brightness of the main display:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
3. Highlight Display and press  
4. Highlight Backlight and press  
.
OK  
.
OK  
.
OK  
5. Highlight Brightness and press  
.
OK  
6. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
Normal sets the Normal mode.  
PowerSave sets the Power Save mode.  
Note:Longbacklightsettingsaffectthebattery’stalkandstandbytimes.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Changing the Screen Saver  
YournewPCSPhoneoffersyou the option of displaying a screen saver  
while in standby mode.  
To assign a screen saver:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Display and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight ScreenSaver and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight the desired mode from options and press  
.
Always to display a screen saver until you change it.  
Weekly to display different screen saver on each day of the  
week. Highlight Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday,  
OK  
Friday, Saturday, or Sunday, and press  
.
SpecialDays to display the screen saver on the special day  
(up to 10 days). To set the special day, enter the month and  
OK  
the day and press  
every year.)  
. (The screen saver appears on the day  
Note: If you set up two or more options, the phone will display a screen saver of  
Special Days, Weekly, or Always in this priority on individual days.  
OK  
6. Highlight your desired display image and press  
.
Off sets no screen saver. (Only appears in Always and Weekly.)  
Pattern includes eight patterns. From the image list,  
highlight an item and select View (left softkey) to display  
the image. (Press the navigation key right or left to display  
OK  
another image.) Press  
to set it to the screen saver.  
Dwnld. ScreenSaver includes downloaded images. Highlight  
your desired image, select Select (left softkey), and press  
OK  
to set it to the screen saver.  
InCamera includes saved pictures taken by camera feature.  
Highlight your desired picture, select Select (left softkey),  
OK  
and press  
to set it to the screen saver.  
Dwnld. /Assigned includes downloaded pictures. Highlight  
your desired picture, select Select (left softkey), and press  
OK  
to set it to the screen saver.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ManagingScreenSaversforSpecialDays  
Once you have assigned screen savers to your special days, you can  
use the Screen Savers menu to view and manage your Special Days  
screen savers.  
To manage your Special Days screen savers:  
MENU  
1 Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Display and press  
.
OK  
OK  
4. Highlight ScreenSaver and press  
.
5. Highlight SpecialDays and press  
.
6. Select List (left softkey) to display assigned Special Days.  
7. Use your navigation key to highlight your desired day.  
8. To view the assigned screen saver, select View (left softkey).  
– or –  
To view options, select Options (right softkey).  
Property to view the assigned screen saver properties.  
Erase to erase the selected special day.  
Changing the Sub Display Contrast  
To adjust the sub display’s contrast:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Display and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Contrast(Sub) and press  
.
5. Adjust the contrast by pressing the navigation key up or down  
OK  
and press  
.
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Changing the Clock Display  
To change the clock’s appearance on the standby screen:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Display and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight IdleScreen and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight MainLCD and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight the desired clock image and press  
.
LargeDigital displays a large digital clock.  
SmallAnalog displays a small analog clock.  
Calendar displays a calendar of the current month.  
SmallDigital displays a small digital clock.  
NoDate&Clock displays no date and no clock.  
LargeAnalog displays a large analog clock.  
NoGuidance displays no softkey label.  
When the list is displayed, you can view the image by selecting View  
(left softkey). You can view the next or previous image by pressing  
the navigation key right or left.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Changing the Sub Display Screen  
Your new PCS Phone offers options for what you see on the sub  
display screen when in standby mode.  
To change the sub display images:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Display and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight IdleScreen and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight SubLCD and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight the desired screen image and press  
.
Digital1-3 displays a digital clock.  
Analog displays an analog clock.  
Digital&Analog displays a digital and analog clocks.  
Pattern includes four clock patterns. From the image list,  
highlight an item and select View (left softkey) to display  
the image. (Press the navigation key right or left to display  
OK  
another image.) Press  
to set it to the screen saver.  
Dwnld. ScreenSaver includes downloaded images. Highlight  
your desired image, select Select (left softkey), and press  
OK  
to set it to the screen saver.  
InCamera includes saved pictures taken by camera feature.  
Highlight your desired image, select Select (left softkey),  
OK  
and press  
to set it to the screen saver.  
Dwnld. /Assigned includes downloaded pictures. Highlight  
your desired image, select Select (left softkey), and press  
OK  
to set it to the screen saver.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Changing the Sub Display Direction  
To change the sub display direction when the clamshell is closed:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Display and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Direction(Sub) and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight the desired option and press  
.
Upward displays information normally when the antenna  
points upward.  
Downward displays information normally when the antenna  
points downward.  
Location Settings  
Your PCS Phone is equipped with a Location feature for use in  
connection with location-based services that may be available  
in the future.  
The Location feature allows the network to detect your position.  
Turning Location off will hide your location from everyone  
except 911.  
Note: Even if the Location feature is enabled, no service may use your location  
without your expressed permission.  
To enable or disable your phone’s Location feature:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
3. Highlight Location and press  
4. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
.
OK  
. (A message will display.)  
5. Read the message (pressing the navigation key down to scroll)  
OK  
and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight On or Off and press  
.
When the Location feature is on, your phone’s standby screen will  
display the  
display.  
icon. When Location is turned off, the  
icon will  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Airplane Mode  
When your phone is in Airplane Mode, it cannot send or receive any  
calls or access online information. You may still use the phone’s other  
features, such as Games, Scheduler, Voice Memos, Camera,  
Camcorder, etc., while you are in Airplane Mode.  
To set your phone to Airplane Mode:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Others and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight AirplaneMode and press  
. (A message will display.)  
OK  
5. Read the message and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight On or Off and press  
.
While in Airplane Mode, your phone’s screen will display “Phone off.”  
TTY Use With PCS Service From Sprint  
A TTY (also known as a TDD or Text Telephone), is a  
telecommunications device that allows people who are deaf or hard  
of hearing, or who have speech or language disabilities, to  
communicate by telephone.  
Your phone is compatible with select TTY devices. Please check with  
the manufacturer of your TTY device to ensure that it supports digital  
wireless transmission. Your phone and TTY device will connect via a  
special cable that plugs into your phone's headset jack. If this cable  
was not provided with your TTY device, contact your TTY device  
manufacturer to purchase the connector cable.  
When establishing your PCS Service, please call PCS Customer  
Solutions via the state Telecommunications Relay Service (TRS) by  
TALK  
7
1
1
first dialing  
this number: 866-727-4889.  
. Then provide the state TRS with  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To turn TTY Mode on or off:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
3. Highlight Others and press  
.
OK  
.
OK  
4. Highlight TTY and press  
. (A message will display.)  
#
#
OK  
8
8
9
Shortcut: From standby mode, press  
and  
.
OK  
5. Read the message and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight Enable or Disable and press  
.
Note: When TTY mode is enabled and a TTY device is connected to the phone's  
jack, your phone will display  
.
Note: If TTY mode is enabled, the audio quality of non-TTY devices connected to  
the headset jack may be impaired.  
Note: Before connecting or disconnecting a cable of the TTY device to or from  
the phone, make sure that the power of the TTY device is turned off. Otherwise,  
the phone may malfunction.  
IMPORTANT NOTICE: 911 Emergency Calling  
Sprint recommends that TTY users make emergency calls by other means  
including Telecommunications Relay Services (TRS), analog cellular, and  
landline communications. Wireless TTY calls to 911 may be corrupted when  
received by public safety answering points (PSAPs) rendering some  
communications unintelligible. The problem encountered appears related to TTY  
equipment or software used by PSAPs. This matter has been brought to the  
attention of the FCC, and the wireless industry and PSAP community are  
currently working to resolve this.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Phone Setup Options  
Setting Open to Answer  
This feature enables you to answer incoming calls by opening the  
TALK  
clamshell so that you don't have to press  
.
To activate or deactivate this feature:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Others and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight OpentoAnswer and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight On or Off and press  
.
Setting Any Key Answer  
This feature allows you to answer incoming calls by pressing any  
digit key.  
To activate or deactivate this feature:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Others and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight AnyKeyAnswer and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight On or Off and press  
.
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Answer Mode  
This feature automatically answers incoming calls after a specified  
duration, when this feature is activated and an external device is  
connected to the phone’s jack.  
To activate or deactivate this feature:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Others and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight AutoAnswer and press  
.
OK  
5. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
**Sec. activates the function with a specified duration (**).  
To change the duration, highlight it, select Edit (right  
softkey), enter a new duration (5 to 30 seconds) and  
OK  
press  
.
Off cancels the function.  
Changing the Language  
Your PCS Phone can display menu options in both English and  
Spanish. The default menu language is English.  
To select English or Spanish for your phone's display:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings (Configuración) and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Others (Otros) and press  
4. Highlight Language (Idioma) and press  
5. Highlight English or Español and press  
.
OK  
OK  
.
.
Setting Speed Dialing  
To enable or disable Speed Dialing (page 87):  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Others and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight SpeedDial and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight Enable or Disable and press  
.
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Phone Book Match Dialing  
To enable or disable Phone Book Match Dialing (page 86):  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Display and press  
.
OK  
OK  
4. Highlight PhonebookMatch and press  
.
5. Highlight Enable or Disable and press  
.
Setting Abbreviated Dialing  
To activate Abbreviated Dialing (page 25):  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Others and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Abbrev. Dial and press  
.
5. Highlight Empty (or a current number) and select Edit (right  
softkey).  
OK  
6. Enter the first six (or five) digits and press  
.
To deactivate this feature:  
1. Follow steps 1 to 4 above.  
OK  
2. Highlight Off and press  
.
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Voice Guidance  
Your phone offers voice guidance capability that informs you of the  
phone’s status and other information in voice and notifies you of  
several events in beep tones. Voice guidance is only available in  
English.  
To activate or deactivate the voice guidance mode:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight VoiceGuidance and press  
.
OK  
4. Read the message and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight VoiceGuidance again and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight On or Off and press  
.
MENU  
Shortcut: From standby mode, press and hold  
to activate or deactivate the  
voice guidance mode. (The phone beeps twice when activated; beeps once  
when deactivated.)  
Note: The voice guidance volume is based on your phone's Ringer Volume. If the  
phone's Ringer Volume is Off or Vib, the voice guidance will be muted. (When you  
MENU  
press and hold  
, the phone vibrates to notify you that no voice guidance is  
available. It vibrates twice for activation or once for deactivation.)  
Note: If Silence All is active, you have no voice guidance, beep tone, or vibrating  
notification.  
To set up the voice guidance options:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight VoiceGuidance and press  
.
OK  
4. Read the message and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight Settings and press  
to display options.  
OK  
6. Highlight the option and press  
. To activate or deactivate  
OK  
the option, highlight On or Off and press  
.
HandsetStatus tells you the phone’s status (the battery level,  
signal strength, roaming status, missed call notification,  
new incoming messages, and phone locked).  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In/OutCall#Guide tells you who is calling you or whom you  
are calling. (The phone reads out a phone number or a  
name displayed on the screen.)  
CallHistoryGuide readsoutthecallhistorywhenyoudisplayit.  
IdleModeGuide beeps when the phone returns to standby  
mode.  
MenuPositionGuide beeps when the first menu item is  
highlighted by scrolling the menu down.  
CallGuardGuide tells you that you are making or answering a  
call with Call Guard enabled.  
To listen to the guidance on the handset status:  
OK  
Pressandhold  
fromstandbymode. (Boththevoiceguidance  
modeandthehandsetstatusoptionshouldbeactivatedinadvance.)  
Note: The voice guidance volume is based on your phone's Ringer Volume. If the  
phone's Ringer Volume is Off or Vib, the phone vibrates once to notify you that no  
voice guidance is available.  
Displaying Your Phone Information  
To display your phone information:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Information and press  
.
OK  
4. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
PhoneInfo to display your phone number, current  
username, and other information about your phone by  
pressing the navigation key up or down.  
LegendofIcons to display the legend of icons by pressing the  
navigation key up or down.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2B: ControllingYour Phones Settings  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2C  
Setting Your Phone’s Security  
In This Section  
AccessingtheSecurityMenu  
LockingYourPhone  
UnlockingYourPhone  
UsingSpecialNumbers  
y using the security settings on your PCS Phone, you receive peace  
Bof mind without sacrificing flexibility. With several options  
available, you can customize your phone to meet your personal needs.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2C: SettingYour Phones Security  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessing the Security Menu  
You must enter your lock code to view the Security menu.  
To access the Security menu:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
.
OK  
3. Highlight Security and press  
4. Enter your four-digit lock code. (The Security menu displays.)  
Tip: If you can’t recall your lock code, try using the last four digits of either your  
Social Security number or PCS Phone Number or try 0000. If none of these work,  
call PCS Customer Solutions at 1-888-211-4PCS (4727).  
Locking Your Phone  
When your phone is locked, you can only receive incoming calls or  
make calls to 911, PCS Customer Solutions, or special numbers.  
To lock your phone:  
1. From the Security menu (see “Accessing the Security Menu” on  
OK  
page 53), highlight LockPhone and press  
.
OK  
2. Highlight LockNow and press  
. (The  
icon will appear.)  
Note: The phone will remain locked even if the power is turned off and on.  
Unlocking Your Phone  
To unlock your phone:  
MENU  
1. Press  
. (You will be prompted to enter your lock code, if  
your phone is locked.)  
2. Enter your four-digit lock code.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2C: SettingYour Phones Security  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locking on Power-up  
When this feature is activated, the phone automatically locks every  
time after it is turned on. To operate, the four-digit lock code must be  
entered.  
To activate this feature:  
1. From the Security menu (see “Accessing the Security Menu” on  
OK  
page 53), highlight LockPhone and press  
.
OK  
2. Highlight OnPower-up and press  
.
To deactivate this feature:  
1. From the Security menu (see “Accessing the Security Menu” on  
OK  
page 53), highlight LockPhone and press  
.
OK  
2. Highlight Unlock and press  
.
Changing the Lock Code  
To change your lock code:  
1. From the Security menu (see “Accessing the Security Menu” on  
OK  
page 53), highlight ChangeLock and press  
2. Enter your new four-digit lock code.  
3. Re-enter your new lock code.  
.
Calling in Lock Mode  
You can place calls to 911 and to your special numbers when in  
lock mode.  
To place an outgoing call in lock mode:  
To call an emergency number, special number, or PCS Customer  
TALK  
Solutions, enter the phone number and press  
.
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2C: SettingYour Phones Security  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Special Numbers  
You can save three special numbers in addition to your internal  
Phone Book entries (the same number may be in both directories).  
You can make and receive calls from special numbers even when  
your phone is locked.  
To add or replace a special number:  
1. From the Security menu (see “Accessing the Security Menu” on  
OK  
page 53), highlight Special#s and press  
.
OK  
2. Highlight a special number’s entry (#1, #2, or #3) and press  
.
OK  
3. Enter the phone number and press  
.
Note:TherearenoSpeedDialoptionsassociatedwithspecialnumbers.  
Erasing the Internal Phone Book  
To erase all the names and phone numbers in your internal Phone  
Book:  
1. From the Security menu (see “Accessing the Security Menu” on  
OK  
page 53), highlight ErasePhoneBook and press  
. (You will  
be prompted to confirm.)  
OK  
2. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Erasing the Downloads  
You can erase all the downloaded contents (games, ringers, screen  
savers, and applications) from the Downloads folder, all the pictures  
from the My Pictures - Downloaded/Assigned folder, and all the  
videos from the My Video - Downloaded/Saved folder at one time.  
This function also erases the contents preloaded into the Downloads  
folder (if applicable).  
To erase contents from these folders:  
1. From the Security menu (see “Accessing the Security Menu” on  
OK  
page 53), highlight EraseDownloads and press  
. (You will  
be prompted to confirm.)  
OK  
2. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Note: IfyouperformtheEraseDownloadsfunction, yourphonewillnolongersound  
ordisplaythecontents(ringers, screensavers, orpictures)thatyouhaveassigned  
tothephonetasks.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2C: SettingYour Phones Security  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Resetting Your Phone  
Resetting the phone restores all the factory defaults, including the  
ringer types and display settings. The internal Phone Book, Call  
History, Scheduler, and Messaging are not affected.  
To reset your phone:  
1. From the Security menu (see “Accessing the Security Menu” on  
OK  
page 53), highlight ResetPhone and press  
. (You will be  
prompted to confirm.)  
OK  
2. Highlight Yes and press  
to reset.  
Resetting Your Picture Mail Password  
To clear your Picture Mail password from your phone:  
1. From the Security menu (see “Accessing the Security Menu” on  
OK  
page 53), highlight ResetPictures/Video and press  
. (You  
will be prompted to confirm.)  
OK  
2. Highlight Yes and press  
to clear.  
Note: You will be prompted to re-enter your Picture Mail password to access  
your Picture Mail account first time after resetting the password.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2C: SettingYour Phones Security  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2D  
Controlling Your Roaming  
Experience  
In This Section  
UnderstandingRoaming  
SettingYourPhone’sRoamMode  
ControllingRoamingChargesUsingCallGuard  
oaming is the ability to make or receive calls when you’re off the  
Renhanced Sprint Nationwide PCS Network. Your new dual band/tri  
mode PCS Phone works anywhere on the enhanced Sprint Nationwide  
PCS Network and allows you to roam on other analog and 1900 and 800  
MHz digital networks where we've implemented roaming agreements  
with other carriers.  
This section explains how roaming works as well as special features that  
let you manage your roaming experience.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2D: ControllingYour Roaming Experience  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding Roaming  
RecognizingIconsontheDisplayScreen  
Your phone’s display screen always lets you know when you’re off  
the enhanced Sprint Nationwide PCS Network and whether your  
phone is operating in analog or digital mode. The following chart  
indicates what you’ll see depending on where you’re using your  
phone.  
Roaming  
Indicator  
Analog  
Indicator  
Sprint Nationwide PCS Network  
Other Digital Networks  
Analog Networks  
– Analog Roam –  
Tip: Remember, when you are using your phone off the Sprint Nationwide  
PCS Network, always dial numbers using 11 digits (1 + area code + number).  
Note: You will pay a higher per-minute rate for roaming calls.  
RoamingonOtherDigitalNetworks  
When you’re roaming on digital networks, your call quality and  
security will be similar to the quality you receive when making calls  
on the enhanced Sprint Nationwide PCS Network. You may not be  
able to access certain features, such as PCS Vision.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2D: ControllingYour Roaming Experience  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
RoamingonAnalogNetworks  
When you roam on analog networks, you will experience a similar  
quality provided by other analog carriers today. Although some  
features, such as PCS Vision and PCS Voice Command, will be  
unavailable, you can still make and receive calls and access voicemail.  
You will experience a few differences:  
You are more likely to experience static, cross-talk, fade-out, and  
dropped calls.  
Some features which are standard on the enhanced  
Sprint Nationwide PCS Network, such as call waiting,  
PCS Vision, and direct international dialing, are unavailable.  
Though callers can leave voicemail messages while you are  
roaming, you will not receive notification until you return to the  
Sprint Nationwide PCS Network. While roaming, you can  
periodically check your voicemail for new messages by dialing  
1+area code+your PCS Phone Number. Press  
when you hear  
your greeting and enter your pass code at the prompt.  
There are security and privacy risks (eavesdropping and cloning)  
that exist with conventional analog services today.  
Your battery needs recharging sooner when you use your phone  
for analog roaming.  
Note: If you’re on a call when you leave the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network  
and enter an area where roaming is available (whether digital or analog),  
your call is dropped. If your call is dropped in an area where you think  
PCS Service is available, turn your phone off and on again to reconnect to  
the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.  
Note: When using your phone in analog mode, the handset may feel warm. This  
behavior is normal for analog operation.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2D: ControllingYour Roaming Experience  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Your Phone’s Roam Mode  
Your PCS Phone allows you to control your ability to roam. By using  
the Roaming menu option, you can determine which signals your  
phone accepts.  
SetMode  
Choose from three different settings on your dual-band/tri-mode  
phone to control your roaming experience:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
3. Highlight Roaming and press  
4. Highlight SetMode and press  
.
OK  
.
OK  
.
OK  
5. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
Sprint: This setting allows you to access the enhanced Sprint  
Nationwide PCS Network only and prevents roaming on  
other networks.  
Automatic: This setting seeks PCS Service. When  
PCS Service is unavailable, the phone searches for an  
alternate system.  
Analog: This setting forces the phone to seek an analog  
roaming system. The previous setting (Sprint or Automatic)  
is restored the next time the phone is turned on.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2D: ControllingYour Roaming Experience  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Controlling Roaming Charges Using  
Call Guard  
In addition to the roaming icon, Call Guard alerts you when roaming  
charges apply. This feature makes it easy to manage your roaming  
charges by reminding you when you make or receive roaming calls. It  
also requires you to take an additional step before placing or  
answering a roaming call. This additional step is not required when  
you make or receive calls while on the enhanced Sprint Nationwide  
PCS Network.  
To turn Call Guard on or off:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
3. Highlight Roaming and press  
4. Highlight CallGuard and press  
5. Highlight On or Off and press  
.
OK  
.
OK  
. (A message will appear.)  
OK  
.
Note: Voice Dialing and Speed Dialing are not available when you are roaming  
with Call Guard enabled.  
To place roaming calls with Call Guard on:  
1. From standby mode, dial 1 + area code + the seven-digit number  
TALK  
and press  
. (You can also initiate a call from the internal  
Phone Book or Call History.)  
1
2. When the prompt appears, press  
to proceed.  
ToanswerincomingroamingcallswithCallGuardon:  
TALK  
1. Press  
.
1
2. When the prompt appears, press  
to proceed.  
Remember if the Call Guard feature is set to On, you need to take extra  
steps to make and receive roaming calls even if you have selected the  
Analogsetting (see page 60).  
Tip: See “Prepending a Phone Number From the Internal Phone Book” on page 86  
and “Prepending a Phone Number From Call History” on page 73.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2D: ControllingYour Roaming Experience  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2E  
Navigating Through Menus  
In This Section  
MenuNavigation  
MenuStructure  
ViewingtheMenus  
his section is a road map to using your PCS Phone. Every function  
Tand feature can be accessed through an onscreen menu. Take  
a few moments to learn your way around and you’ll find your phone  
easier to use.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2E: NavigatingThrough Menus  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Menu Navigation  
The navigation key on your PCS Phone allows you to scroll through  
menus quickly and easily.  
To navigate through a menu, simply press the navigation key up or  
down.  
Menu Structure  
SelectingMenuItems  
As you navigate through the menu, menu options are highlighted.  
Select any numbered option by simply pressing the corresponding  
number on the phone’s keypad. You may also select any item by  
OK  
highlighting it and pressing  
.
For example, if you want to view your last incoming call:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
1
2. Select CallHistory by pressing  
pressing  
or by highlighting it and  
OK  
. (It may already be highlighted.)  
2
3. Select IncomingCalls by pressing  
pressing  
or by highlighting it and  
OK  
. If you have received any calls, they are displayed  
on the screen.  
BackingUpWithinaMenu  
To go to the previous menu:  
BACK  
Press  
.
To return to standby mode:  
END  
Press  
.
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2E: NavigatingThrough Menus  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MainMenu'sView  
The Main Menu appears in two ways: thumbnail view and list view.  
To switch the Main Menu between the thumbnail view and list view,  
select Options (right softkey) from the Main Menu display, highlight  
OK  
ThumbnailView or ListView, and press  
.
MainMenuOptionsinThumbnailView  
From the thumbnail view of the Main Menu, select Options (right  
softkey) to display menu options. To select an option, highlight it and  
OK  
press  
.
ListView to switch the main menu screen into the list view.  
SetScreenSaver to select the background view from options (Off,  
Pattern, Dwnld. ScreenSaver, InCamera, and Dwnld./Assigned).  
SetButtonIcon to select an image for an individual box from  
options (Off, Pattern, Dwnld. ScreenSaver, InCamera, and  
Dwnld./Assigned).  
TitleView to turn the menu titles on the thumbnail view On or Off.  
MainMenuOptionsinListView  
From the list view of the Main Menu, select Options (right softkey) to  
OK  
display menu options. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
ThumbnailView to switch the main menu screen into the  
thumbnail view.  
SetScreenSaver to select the background view from options (Off,  
Pattern, Dwnld. ScreenSaver, InCamera, and Dwnld./Assigned).  
ThumbnailView  
ListView  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2E: NavigatingThrough Menus  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Viewing the Menus  
MenuDiagram  
The following list outlines your phone’s menu structure.  
1. Call History  
1. Outgoing Calls  
2. Incoming Calls  
3. Missed Calls  
4. Scratch Pad  
5. Erase History  
1. Outgoing Calls  
2. Incoming Calls  
3. Missed Calls  
4. Scratch Pad  
5. All  
2. Phone Book  
1. Find Name  
2. Add New Entry  
3. Speed Dial #s  
4. Voice Dial  
5. Group List  
6. Services  
1. Account Info  
2. Customer Care  
3. Directory Assist  
3. Messaging  
1. Send message  
1. Send Picture Mail  
2. Send Video Mail  
3. Send Text Message  
4. Email  
2. Picture Mail  
1. Inbox  
2. Erase  
3. Text Msg.  
1. Inbox  
2. Outbox  
3. Send message  
4. Erase  
4. Email  
5. Voicemail  
1. Call Voicemail  
2. Details  
3. Clear Icon  
4. Web  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2E: NavigatingThrough Menus  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Downloads  
Games  
Ringers  
Screen Savers  
Applications  
Others  
6. Pictures/Video  
1. Camera  
2. Camcorder  
3. My Pictures  
1. In Camera  
2. Downloaded/Assigned  
4. My Video  
1. In Camcorder  
2. Downloaded/Saved  
5. Online Albums  
6. Account Info  
7. Voicemail  
1. Call Voicemail  
2. Details  
3. Clear Icon  
8. Settings  
1. Sounds  
1. Volume  
2. Ringer Type  
3. Alerts  
4. Key Tone Length  
2. Display  
1. Backlight  
2. Greeting  
3. Contrast (Sub)  
4. Phonebook Match  
5. Screen Saver  
6. Idle Screen  
7. Direction (Sub)  
3. PCS Vision  
1. Enable/Disable PCS Vision  
2. Net Guard  
3. Update Profile  
4. Roaming  
1. Set Mode  
2. Call Guard  
5. Location  
1. Settings  
6. Messaging  
1. Display Pop-up  
2. Save Sent Message  
3. Default Callback #  
4. Entry Mode  
5. Signature  
6. Display Font Size  
7. Preset Messages  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2E: NavigatingThrough Menus  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Security  
1. Lock Phone  
2. Change Lock  
3. Erase Phone Book  
4. Erase Downloads  
5. Reset Phone  
6. Reset Pictures/Video  
7. Special #s  
8. Information  
1. Phone Info  
2. Legend of Icons  
9. Others  
1. Open to Answer  
2. Any Key Answer  
3. Auto Answer  
4. Airplane Mode  
5. Language  
6. Speed Dial  
7. Abbrev. Dial  
8. TTY  
0. Voice Guidance  
1. Voice Guidance  
2. Settings  
9. Tools  
1. Voice Memo  
1. Record  
2. Play  
3. Erase All  
2. Calculator  
3. Scheduler  
4. Alarm  
1. Notice  
2. Time  
3. Ringer Volume  
4. Ringer Type  
5. Countdown Timer  
1. Time  
2. Ringer Volume  
3. Ringer Type  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2E: NavigatingThrough Menus  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
My Menu  
In addition to the main menu, your phone offers you a My Menu  
function. You can customize My Menu, a group of shortcuts to the  
phone's various tasks, for your efficient use of the phone.  
To display My Menu:  
From standby mode, press the navigation key up ( ).  
– or –  
From the main menu, select MyMenu (left softkey).  
MyMenu'sView  
My Menu appears in two ways: thumbnail view and list view.  
To switch My Menu between the thumbnail view and list view, select  
Options (right softkey) from the My Menu display, highlight Thumbnail  
OK  
View or ListView, and press  
.
AddingaShortcuttoMyMenu  
1. From standby mode, press the navigation key up ( ). (My  
Menu displays.)  
2. Highlight the empty menu item you want to assign a phone task  
to and select Options (right softkey). (Menu options will  
display).  
OK  
3. Highlight AssigntoMyMenu and press  
. (A group of phone  
task icons appears.)  
4. Use your navigation key to scroll through phone tasks.  
OK  
5. Highlight your desired task and press  
to save the setting.  
(The new My Menu displays.)  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2E: NavigatingThrough Menus  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MyMenuOptionsinThumbnailView  
From the thumbnail view of My Menu, select Options (right softkey)  
to display menu options. To select an option, highlight it and press  
OK  
.
ListView to switch the My Menu screen into the list view.  
AssigntoMyMenu to select a function from options for the menu  
item.  
EditTitle to edit the title of the menu item.  
Erase to clear the menu item.  
EraseAll to clear all the menu items in My Menu.  
SetScreenSaver to select the background view from options (Off,  
Pattern, Dwnld. ScreenSaver, InCamera, and Dwnld./Assigned).  
SetButtonIcon to select an image for an individual box from  
options (Off, Pattern, Dwnld. ScreenSaver, InCamera, and  
Dwnld./Assigned).  
TitleView to turn the menu titles on thumbnail view On or Off.  
MyMenuOptionsinListView  
From the list view of My Menu, select Options (right softkey) to display  
OK  
menu options. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
ThumbnailView to switch the My Menu screen into the thumbnail  
view.  
AssigntoMyMenu to select a function from options for the menu  
item.  
EditTitle to edit the title of the menu item.  
Erase to clear the menu item.  
EraseAll to clear all the menu items in My Menu.  
SetScreenSaver to select the background view from options (Off,  
Pattern, Dwnld. ScreenSaver, InCamera, and Dwnld./Assigned).  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2E: NavigatingThrough Menus  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2F  
Managing Call History  
In This Section  
ViewingHistory  
CallHistoryOptions  
MakingaCallFromCallHistory  
SavingaPhoneNumberFromCallHistory  
ErasingCallHistory  
he Call History keeps track of incoming calls, calls made from your  
TPCS Phone, and missed calls. This section guides you through  
accessing and making the most of your Call History.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2F: Managing Call History  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Viewing History  
You’ll find the Call History feature very helpful. It is a list of the last 20  
phone numbers (or internal Phone Book entries) for calls you placed,  
accepted, or missed. Call History makes redialing a number fast and  
easy. It is continually updated as new numbers are added to the  
beginning of the list and the oldest entries are removed from the  
bottom of the list.  
Each entry contains the phone number (if it is available) and internal  
Phone Book entry name (if the phone number is in your internal  
Phone Book). Duplicate calls (same number and type of call) may  
only appear once on the list.  
To view a Call History entry:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight CallHistory and press  
.
3. Highlight OutgoingCalls, IncomingCalls, MissedCalls, or Scratch  
OK  
Pad and press  
. (A list of calls will display.)  
4. Use your navigation key to scroll through the list.  
Call History Options  
For additional information and options on a particular call, highlight  
OK  
a Call History entry and press  
. This feature displays the time and  
date of the call and, by using the right softkey (Options), gives you the  
option of selecting:  
Call to dial the phone number.  
Save to save the phone number to your internal Phone Book.  
Erase to erase the phone number.  
PrependDial to add an area code before dialing. (See “Prepending  
a Phone Number From Call History” on page 73.)  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2F: Managing Call History  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Making a Call From Call History  
To place a call from Call History:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight CallHistory and press  
.
3. Highlight OutgoingCalls, IncomingCalls, MissedCalls, or Scratch  
OK  
Pad and press  
. (A list of calls will display.)  
4. Highlight the entry you want to call by scrolling through the list.  
TALK  
5. Press  
to dial.  
Note: You cannot make calls from Call History to entries identified as  
No ID or Restricted.  
Saving a Phone Number From Call History  
Your PCS Phone can store up to 300 internal Phone Book entries.  
A Phone Book entry can store up to five phone numbers.  
To save a phone number from Call History:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight CallHistory and press  
.
3. Highlight OutgoingCalls, IncomingCalls, MissedCalls, or Scratch  
OK  
Pad and press  
. (A list of calls will display.)  
4. Highlight the entry you want to save and select Options (right  
softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Save and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight NewEntry and press  
.
7. Selectaniconfromtheoptions(  
Home,  
Work,  
Mobile,  
OK  
andmore)andpress  
.
OK  
8. To enter a name, highlight the  
icon, press  
, enter the  
OK  
name, and press  
.
9. Select Save (left softkey) to save the new entry.  
Tip: You can also save numbers from Call History to existing Phone Book entries.  
Just select Add to Contact in step 6 above, use your navigation key to select an  
entry and a label icon, and select Save to save the new number.  
Note: You cannot save phone numbers from calls identified as No ID or Restricted.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2F: Managing Call History  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Prepending a Phone Number From Call History  
If you need to make a call from Call History and you happen to be  
outside your local area code, you can add the appropriate prefix by  
following these steps:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight CallHistory and press  
.
3. Highlight OutgoingCalls, IncomingCalls, MissedCalls, or Scratch  
OK  
Pad and press  
. (A list of calls will display.)  
4. Highlight the entry you want to prepend.  
5. Select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
6. Highlight PrependDial and press  
.
7. Enter the digits you want to add to the number. (The change  
only applies to the current call.)  
TALK  
8. Press  
to dial.  
Erasing Call History  
To erase Call History lists:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight CallHistory and press  
3. Highlight EraseHistory and press  
.
OK  
.
4. Highlight the category you want to erase (OutgoingCalls,  
IncomingCalls, MissedCalls, ScratchPad, or All) and press  
(You will be prompted to confirm.)  
OK  
.
OK  
5. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Tip: To erase individual Call History entries, see Call History Optionson page 71.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2F: Managing Call History  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2G  
Using the Internal Phone Book  
In This Section  
InternalPhoneBookEntryOptions  
AddingaNewInternalPhoneBookEntry  
FindingInternalPhoneBookEntries  
SelectingaRingerType  
DialingPCSServices  
ow you know the basics that make it easier to stay in touch with  
Npeople and information. This section helps you make the most of  
your contacts and time when you are trying to connect with the  
important people in your life.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Internal Phone Book Entry Options  
Your PCS Phone can store up to 300 internal Phone Book entries.  
Phone book entries can store up to five phone numbers, three email  
addresses, and one Web address (URL) per entry. In addition, various  
options are available for your convenience.  
To access an internal Phone Book entry’s options:  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
OK  
2. Highlight an entry and press  
. (The Details screen  
appears.)  
3. Highlight the phone number, email address, or Web address you  
wish to view and select Options (right softkey) to display the  
entry’s options.  
OK  
4. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
Call to dial the phone number.  
SetSpeedDial to add the phone number to the Speed Dial list  
(see page 87).  
SetVoiceDial to add a Voice Dial tag to the phone number  
(see page 102).  
PrependDial to dial by adding digits to the phone number  
(see page 86).  
GotoURL togototheWebsite(onlyappearsinWebaddresses).  
SendTextMsg. togotothemessagingfeaturetosendamessage  
(onlyappearsinphonenumbersandemailaddresses).  
Tip: Additional options are available when you are in the Edit screen. See Edit  
Entry Optionson page 80.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adding a New Internal Phone Book Entry  
Your PCS Phone can store up to 300 internal Phone Book entries.  
Phone book entries can store up to five phone numbers, three email  
addresses, and one Web address (URL) per entry.  
To add a new entry:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight AddNewEntry and press  
. (The Add New Entry  
screen appears.)  
OK  
4. To enter a name, highlight  
the name (up to 36 characters) and press  
<Name> and press  
. Enter  
OK  
.
5. To enter a phone number, highlight  
<Number> and press  
OK  
OK  
. Enter the phone number (up to 32 digits) and press  
.
Selectaniconfromtheoptions(  
Home,  
Work,  
Mobile,  
OK  
andmore)andpress  
.
OK  
6. To enter an email address, highlight  
Enter the email address (up to 48 characters) and press  
<E-mail> and press  
.
OK  
.
.
OK  
OK  
7. To enter a Web address, highlight <URL> and press  
Enter the Web address (up to 48 characters) and press  
8. Select Save (left softkey) to save the new entry.  
– or –  
.
OK  
1. From standby mode, enter a phone number and press  
.
OK  
2. Highlight NewEntry and press  
.
3. Selectaniconfromtheoptions(  
Home,  
Work,  
Mobile,  
OK  
andmore)andpress  
.
OK  
4. To enter a name, highlight  
<Name> and press  
. Enter  
OK  
the name and press  
.
5. Select Save (left softkey) to save the new entry.  
Note: Make sure that mobile phone numbers are always labeled with the mobile  
icon so they can be used for Messaging. From the Messaging menu, you can  
only select phone numbers labeled with the mobile  
icon and email addresses.  
Tip: When the Add New Entry screen appears, you can assign a picture to the entry  
so the picture will display for incoming calls from the specific caller (see page 81).  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Finding Internal Phone Book Entries  
There are several ways to display your internal Phone Book entries.  
Follow the steps outlined in the sections below to display entries  
from the internal Phone Book menu.  
FindingNames  
You can review all the entries stored in your internal Phone Book or  
find an entry quickly by following these simple steps:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight FindName and press  
. (Your internal Phone Book  
list appears.)  
Shortcut: From standby mode, press the navigation key right ( ) to display  
your internal Phone Book list.  
4. Press the navigation key left or right to scroll through pages or  
enter the first letters of a name to find the entry.  
OK  
5. Highlight the entry and press  
. (The Details screen  
appears.)  
TALK  
6. To dial a phone number, highlight it and press  
.
FindingSpeedDialNumbers  
To find phone numbers you have stored in speed dial locations:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight SpeedDial#’s and press  
. (The Speed Dial list  
appears.)  
4. Press the navigation key left or right to scroll through pages or  
enter the location number (2-99) to find the entry.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FindingVoiceDialNumbers  
To find phone numbers you have stored in Voice Dial:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight VoiceDial and press  
. (The Voice Dial List  
appears.)  
4. Press the navigation key left or right to scroll through pages to  
find the entry.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adding a Phone Number or Address to an Internal  
Phone Book Entry  
To add a phone number, email address, or Web address to an entry:  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
2. Highlight the entry you wish to add a number or address to and  
OK  
press  
. (The Details screen appears.)  
3. Select Edit (left softkey). (The Edit screen appears.)  
4. Enter the new phone number, email address, or URL.  
To enter a phone number, highlight an empty item with the  
OK  
icon and press  
. Enter the phone number and  
OK  
press  
. Select an icon from the options (  
Home,  
.
OK  
Work,  
Mobile, and more) and press  
To enter an email address, highlight an empty item with the  
OK  
icon and press  
.
. Enter the email address and press  
OK  
To enter a Web address, highlight an empty item with the  
OK  
icon and press  
.
. Enter the Web address and press  
OK  
5. Select Save (left softkey) to save the changed entry.  
– or –  
OK  
1. From standby mode, enter a phone number and press  
.
OK  
2. Highlight AddtoContact and press  
. (Your internal Phone  
Book list appears.)  
OK  
3. Highlight the entry you wish to add the number to and press  
.
4. Selectaniconfromtheoptions(  
Home,  
Work,  
Mobile,  
OK  
andmore)andpress  
.
5. Select Save (left softkey) to save the changed entry.  
Note: Make sure that mobile phone numbers are always labeled with the mobile  
icon so they can be used for Messaging. From the Messaging menu, you can  
only select phone numbers labeled with the mobile  
icon and email addresses.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing an Internal Phone Book Entry  
To make changes to an entry:  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
OK  
2. Highlight the entry you wish to edit and press  
. (The  
Details screen appears.)  
3. Select Edit (left softkey). (The Edit screen appears.)  
4. Highlight the name, phone number, email address, or Web  
OK  
address you wish to edit and press  
.
5. Enter a new name, phone number, email address, or Web  
OK  
BACK  
address and press  
. (Press  
to erase a digit or letter;  
BACK  
press and hold  
to erase all digits or letters.)  
6. Select Save (left softkey) to save the changed entry.  
Tip: When the Edit screen appears, you can assign a picture to the entry so the  
picture will display for incoming calls from the specific caller (see page 81).  
EditEntryOptions  
When the Edit screen displays, the following options are available by  
selecting Options (right softkey). To select an option, highlight it and  
OK  
press  
.
Icon to select an icon for the phone number (see page 84).  
Ringer to select a ringer type for the phone number and email  
address (see page 82).  
SpeedDial to add the phone number to the Speed Dial list.  
Secret to make a phone number, email address, and Web address  
secret (see page 83).  
Replace to change the order of phone numbers and email  
addresses in an entry (see page 84).  
Erase to erase an item (see page 85).  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Assigning a Picture to an Entry  
You can assign a picture to an internal Phone Book entry so the  
picture will display for incoming calls from the specific caller.  
To select a picture for an entry:  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
OK  
2. Highlight the entry and press  
. (The Details screen  
appears.)  
3. Select Edit (left softkey). (The Edit screen appears.)  
OK  
4. Highlight the  
icon and press  
.
5. Highlight Dwnld. ScreenSaver, InCamera, or Dwnld. /Assigned  
OK  
and press  
. (Thumbnail pictures will display.)  
Dwnld. ScreenSaver includes Screen Savers downloaded  
with the Downloads menu.  
InCamera includes the pictures saved in your camera.  
Dwnld. /Assigned includes the pictures downloaded to My  
Pictures.  
6. Using your navigation key, highlight the desired picture.  
7. Select Select (left softkey). (The selected picture will display.)  
OK  
8. Press  
. (You will return to the Edit screen.)  
9. Select Save (left softkey) to save the entry.  
To cancel the picture assignment from an entry:  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
OK  
2. Highlight the entry and press  
. (The Details screen appears.)  
3. Select Edit (left softkey). (The Edit screen appears.)  
4. Highlight the  
icon and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Remove and press  
. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
6. Highlight Yes and press  
.
7. Select Save (left softkey) to save the changed entry.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting a Ringer Type for a Phone Number  
You can assign a ringer type to a phone number in an internal Phone  
Book entry so you can identify the caller by the ringer type.  
To select a ringer type for a phone number:  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
OK  
2. Highlight the entry and press  
. (The Details screen  
appears.)  
3. Select Edit (left softkey). (The Edit screen appears.)  
4. Highlight the phone number and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Ringer and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight one of the categories listed below and press  
.
Pattern1 includes 9 ringer tones.  
Pattern2 includes 9 alarm tones.  
Melody includes 9 melodies.  
Downloads includes the ringers you have downloaded (see  
page 181).  
VoiceMemo includes the voice memos you have recorded  
with the Voice Memo feature (see page 105).  
Common clears a specific ringer type.  
OK  
7. Highlight your desired ringer type and press  
. (The Edit  
screen appears. A new ringer icon displays at the bottom of the  
screen when the number is highlighted.)  
8. Select Save (left softkey) to save the new ringer type.  
Tip: Ringer types may also be assigned to email addresses.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Secret Phone Numbers  
You can hide an entry’s phone numbers by making them secret. The  
entry name is still displayed, but the entry’s phone numbers are  
replaced by “Secret”. A secret number requires your lock code each  
time you access it.  
To make a phone number secret:  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
OK  
2. Highlight the entry and press  
. (The Details screen appears.)  
3. Select Edit (left softkey). (The Edit screen appears.)  
4. Highlight the phone number and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Secret and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight On and press  
. (The Edit screen appears. The  
icon displays at the bottom of the screen when the secret  
number is highlighted.)  
7. Select Save (left softkey) to save the entry.  
Tip: You may also make an entrys email addresses and Web address (URL)  
secret.  
To make a phone number public:  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
OK  
2. Highlight the entry and press  
. (The Details screen appears.)  
3. Select Edit (left softkey).  
4. Enter your lock code. (The Edit screen appears.)  
5. Highlight the secret number and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
6. Highlight Secret and press  
.
OK  
7. Highlight Off and press  
.
8. Select Save (left softkey) to save the new setting.  
Tip: If you cant recall your lock code, try using the last four digits of either your  
Social Security number or PCS Phone Number or try 0000. If none of these work,  
call PCS Customer Solutions at 1-888-211-4PCS (4727).  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Changing an Icon for a Phone Number  
To change an icon for a phone number:  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
OK  
2. Highlight the entry and press  
. (The Details screen  
appears.)  
3. Select Edit (left softkey). (The Edit screen appears.)  
4. Highlight the phone number and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Icon and press  
.
6. Select your desired icon from options (  
Home,  
Work,  
OK  
Mobile, and more) and press  
.
7. Select Save (left softkey) to save the icon.  
Note: Make sure that mobile phone numbers are always labeled with the mobile  
icon so they can be used for Messaging. From the Messaging menu, you can  
only select phone numbers labeled with the mobile  
icon and email addresses.  
Changing the Order of Phone Numbers  
You can interchange any two phone numbers in the same entry.  
To change the order of phone numbers:  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
OK  
2. Highlight the entry and press  
. (The Details screen  
appears.)  
3. Select Edit (left softkey). (The Edit screen appears.)  
4. Highlight the phone number you wish to change the order and  
select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Replace and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight another phone number and press  
. (The two  
phone numbers will be interchanged.)  
7. Select Save (left softkey) to save the changed entry.  
Tip: You may change the order of email addresses in the same entry.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Erasing Phone Numbers  
To erase an individual phone number, email address, or Web address  
(URL):  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
OK  
2. Highlight the entry and press  
. (The Details screen  
appears.)  
3. Select Edit (left softkey). (The Edit screen appears.)  
4. Highlight the item you wish to erase and select Options (right  
softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Erase and press  
. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
6. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase the item.  
7. Select Save (left softkey) to save the changed entry.  
Erasing Internal Phone Book Entries  
To erase an internal Phone Book entry:  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
2. Highlight the entry and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
3. Highlight Erase and press  
. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
4. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase the entry.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dialing PCS Services  
You must be in digital mode to access PCS Services.  
To dial a service:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Services and press  
.
4. Highlight AccountInfo, CustomerCare, or DirectoryAssist and  
TALK  
press  
.
Phone Book Match Dialing  
You can make a call by entering the last several digits of a phone  
number when this feature is activated. (See “Setting Phone Book  
Match Dialing” on page 49.)  
To make a call with Phone Book Match Dialing enabled:  
1. From standby mode, enter the last 3-6 digits of a phone number.  
TALK  
2. Press  
. (The matching internal Phone Book entries will  
display.)  
3. Highlight the name or phone number you wish to dial and  
TALK  
press  
.
Prepending a Phone Number  
From the Internal Phone Book  
This feature allows you to make a call by adding digits to a phone  
number saved in your internal Phone Book. If phone numbers have  
been saved without an area code and you are outside your local area  
code, you can make a call by following these steps:  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
OK  
2. Highlight the entry and press  
. (The Details screen appears.)  
3. Highlight the phone number and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
4. Highlight PrependDial and press  
.
5. Enter the digits you want to add to the number. (The change  
only applies to the current call.)  
TALK  
6. Press  
to dial.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speed Dialing  
With this feature activated, you can dial Speed Dial entries using one  
key press for locations 2-9 or two key presses for locations 10-99. The  
Speed Dial locations are assigned to individual phone numbers in  
your internal Phone Book entries. (See “Setting Speed Dialing” on  
page 48.)  
AssigningaSpeedDialLocation  
To assign the speed dial location to a phone number:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight SpeedDial#’s and press  
. (Your Speed Dial list  
appears.)  
4. Highlight <Empty> by using the navigation key (or enter a  
location number 2 to 99) and select Select (left softkey). (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears. This list only includes entries  
with phone numbers that are not yet assigned for the speed dial.)  
5. Highlight your desired internal Phone Book entry and  
OK  
press  
.
6. Highlight the phone number you wish to add to the Speed Dial  
list and select Save (left softkey) to save. (The new Speed Dial  
list appears.)  
– or –  
1. Press the navigation key right ( ) from standby mode. (Your  
internal Phone Book list appears.)  
OK  
2. Highlight your desired entry and press  
. (The Details  
screen appears.)  
3. Highlight the phone number you wish to add to the Speed Dial  
list and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
4. Highlight SetSpeedDial and press  
. (Your Speed Dial list  
appears.)  
5. Highlight <Empty> by using the navigation key (or enter a  
OK  
location number 2 to 99) and press  
to save.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UsingSpeedDial2-9  
To use one-touch speed dialing:  
From standby mode, press and hold the appropriate key for  
approximately one second.  
UsingSpeedDial10-99  
To use two-touch speed dialing:  
1. From standby mode, press the first digit key.  
2. Press and hold the second digit key for approximately one second.  
ChangingSpeedDialLocations  
To change the speed dial location for a phone number:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight SpeedDial#’s and press  
.
4. Highlight the speed dial entry that you wish to move and select  
Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Move and press  
.
OK  
6. Highlight <Empty> from the Speed Dial list and press  
.
Note: You can only move speed dial entries to unused speed dial locations.  
ClearingaSpeedDialEntry  
To clear a speed dial entry from your Speed Dial list:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight SpeedDial#’s and press  
.
4. Highlight the speed dial entry that you wish to clear and select  
Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Remove and press  
. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
6. Highlight Yes and press  
. (The speed dial entry will be  
cleared, but the phone number will still remain in your internal  
Phone Book.)  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Group List  
You can save up to 10 mobile phone numbers or email addresses with  
name in your Group List. This helps you send text/picture messages  
to multiple addresses at a time.  
AddinganEntrytoYourGroupList  
To add an entry to the group list:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight GroupList and press  
.
4. Highlight <Empty> and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Edit and press  
.
6. Enter a name and address.  
OK  
Highlight EnterName and press  
. Enter the name and  
OK  
press  
.
OK  
Highlight EnterAddress and press  
. Enter the mobile  
OK  
phone number or email address and press  
.
7. Select Save (left softkey). (You will be prompted to confirm.)  
OK  
8. Highlight Yes and press  
to save.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CopyinganEntryFromtheInternalPhoneBook  
To copy a mobile phone number or email address from the internal  
Phone Book entries to the group list:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight GroupList and press  
.
4. Highlight <Empty> and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight GetPhoneBook and press  
. (Your internal Phone  
Book list appears.)  
OK  
6. Highlight the entry and press  
. (The Details screen appears.)  
7. Highlight the mobile phone number or email address that you  
OK  
wish to copy to the group list and press  
.
8. Select Save (left softkey). (You will be prompted to confirm.)  
OK  
9. Highlight Yes and press  
.
Note: The group list is saved in a separate memory location from your internal  
Phone Book. Changes in your internal Phone Book are not reflected on your  
group list.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EditinganEntryinYourGroupList  
To edit a name, mobile phone number, or email address in the group  
list:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight GroupList and press  
.
4. Highlight an entry to edit and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Edit and press  
.
6. Edit a name, mobile phone number, or email address.  
OK  
To edit a name, highlight the name and press  
. Enter a  
OK  
new name and press  
.
To edit a mobile phone number or email address, highlight  
OK  
it and press  
. Enter a new mobile phone number or  
OK  
email address and press  
.
7. Select Save (left softkey). (You will be prompted to confirm.)  
OK  
8. Highlight Yes and press  
to save.  
ErasinganEntryFromYourGroupList  
To erase an entry from the group list:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight GroupList and press  
.
4. Highlight an entry and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Erase and press  
. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
6. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2G: Using the Internal Phone Book  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2H  
Personal Organizer  
In This Section  
AddinganEventtotheScheduler  
EventAlerts  
ViewingEvents  
UsingtheAlarmClock  
UsingYourPhone’sTools  
our PCS Phone is equipped with several personal information  
Ymanagement features that help you manage your busy lifestyle.  
These features turn your phone into a time management planner that  
helps you keep up with your contacts, schedules, and commitments. It  
takes productivity to a whole new level.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2H: Personal Organizer  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adding an Event to the Scheduler  
Your Scheduler helps organize your time and reminds you of up to 30  
important events.  
To add an event:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Tools and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Scheduler and press  
. (The current month's  
calendar displays.)  
4. To display another month, select Month (left softkey), change  
OK  
the month/year using the navigation key, and press  
.
5. Highlight the day you want to add an event to using the  
OK  
navigation key and press  
.
6. Select Options (right softkey) to display menu options.  
OK  
7. Highlight NewEvent and press  
. (The Edit Schedule screen  
appears.)  
OK  
8. Highlight From and press  
. Enter the time to begin and  
OK  
press  
.
OK  
9. Highlight To and press  
. Enter the time to finish and press  
OK  
.
OK  
10. Highlight Description and press  
. Enter the text and press  
OK  
.
11. To set the event alarm options, highlight AlarmSet and press  
OK  
. (See “Event Alarm Options” on page 94.) Saving the  
options will return to this menu item.  
OK  
12. To repeat the event alarm, highlight Repeat and press  
.
Select an option (None, Daily, Weekly, Monthly or Yearly), and  
OK  
press  
.
13. Select Save (left softkey) to save the new event.  
Tip: When an event alarm is set, the icon  
the scheduled date.  
will appear in the standby mode on  
Tip:PressthenavigationkeyupordowntoscrollbyweekthroughtheScheduler  
calendar.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2H: Personal Organizer  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Event Alarm Options  
When the Alarm Set screen appears with the following scheduler  
OK  
alarm options, select the desired option then press  
option settings, select Save (left softkey). This will return to the  
original menu item on the Edit Schedule screen.  
. To save the  
AlarmSet: Activates or deactivates the event alarm. Highlight On  
OK  
or Off and press  
.
AlarmTime: Shifts the alarm in advance for a scheduled event.  
Select an option (5Min. Before, 30Min. Before, 1Hr. Before, or On  
OK  
Time) then press  
.
RingerType: Selects a ringer type for the alarm (Pattern1, Pattern2,  
Melody, Downloads, or VoiceMemo).  
RingerVolume: Adjusts the alarm volume (Level 1 to 5, or Off).  
AnimationType: Selects animation for the alarm from Preloaded  
(Work, Dinner, Leisure, Business, Meeting or Anniversary),  
Dwnld. ScreenSaver, InCamera, or Dwnld./Assigned. (When the  
OK  
image list is displayed, you can view the image by pressing  
.
To view the next image, press the navigation key right. To return  
BACK  
to the image list, press  
.)  
Event Alerts  
When your phone is turned on and you have an event alarm  
scheduled, your phone alerts you and displays the event summary.  
There are several ways your PCS Phone alerts you of scheduled events:  
By playing the assigned ringer type.  
By illuminating the backlight.  
By flashing the LED red.  
OK  
To silence the alarm and reset the schedule, press  
.
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2H: Personal Organizer  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Viewing Events  
To view your scheduled events on a specific day:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Tools and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Scheduler and press  
. (The current month’s  
calendar displays.)  
4. To display another month, select Month (left softkey), change  
OK  
the month/year using your navigation key, and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight a day you want to view and press  
. (The  
scheduled events will display.)  
Tip: A day marked blue has scheduled events. When you highlight the day, the  
number of events on the day will display at the upper right corner of the screen.  
Note: A repeating event is only displayed on the first scheduled date. Once the  
event alarm is notified on the first scheduled date, then the event will be  
displayed on the next scheduled date.  
To view all the scheduled events:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Tools and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Scheduler and press  
4. Select Options (right softkey).  
.
OK  
5. Highlight AllEvents and press  
. (A chronological list of all  
events will display.)  
Erasing a Day’s Events  
To erase a scheduled day’s events:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Tools and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Scheduler and press  
.
4. Select the day and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight EraseDay and press  
. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
6. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2H: Personal Organizer  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Purging Events  
To delete events scheduled before a specific time and date:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Tools and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Scheduler and press  
.
4. Select the day and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight EraseBefore and press  
. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
6. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Purging All Events  
To delete all scheduled events:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Tools and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Scheduler and press  
.
4. Select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight EraseAll and press  
. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
6. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2H: Personal Organizer  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Alarm Clock  
Your phone comes with a built-in alarm clock function.  
To set the alarm clock:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Tools and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Alarm and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Notice and press  
and press  
. To set the alarm, highlight On  
OK  
OK  
. (To deactivate, highlight Off and press  
.)  
OK  
5. Highlight Time and press  
. Enter the alarm time and press  
OK  
1
2
. (Press  
for a.m. or  
for p.m.)  
OK  
6. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
Notice sets the alarm on or off.  
Time sets the time of alarm.  
RingerVolume adjusts the alarm volume (Level 1 to 5, or Off).  
RingerType selects a ringer type for the alarm. See “Ringer  
Types” on page 31.  
END  
7. To exit, press  
. (The  
icon will appear.)  
When your phone is turned on and you have set the alarm, the clock  
will sound an alarm with animation at the specified time. This will  
repeat every day until you deactivate it. (If you are on a call, the alarm  
will sound after the call.)  
To turn off the alarm when ringing:  
OK  
END  
Press  
or  
.
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2H: Personal Organizer  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Countdown Timer  
Your phone comes with a built-in countdown timer function.  
To set the countdown timer:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Tools and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight CountdownTimer and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Time, press  
and press  
, enter the duration (1 to 99 minutes),  
OK  
. (The timer will start.)  
OK  
5. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
Time sets the duration.  
RingerVolume adjusts the alarm volume (Level 1 to 5, or Off).  
RingerType selects a ringer type for the alarm. See “Ringer  
Types” on page 31.  
END  
6. To exit, press  
. (The  
icon will appear.)  
To cancel the countdown timer after it has started:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Tools and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight CountdownTimer and press  
.
4. Select Stop (right softkey) to cancel.  
When the timer expires, the phone will sound an alarm with  
animation. (If you are on a call, the alarm will sound after the call.)  
To turn off the alarm when ringing:  
OK  
END  
Press  
or  
.
Note: Turning the phone off cancels the countdown timer.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2H: Personal Organizer  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Your Phone’s Tools  
In addition to features designed to help make you more efficient  
and organized, your new PCS Phone also offers tools for your  
entertainment and amusement.  
Using the Calculator  
Your phone comes with a built-in calculator function.  
To use the calculator:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Tools and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Calculator and press  
.
4. Enter a number using your keypad. To insert a decimal point,  
BACK  
press the left softkey. To clear the number, press  
.
5. Press the appropriate navigation key for an arithmetic option.  
( for addition, for subtraction, for multiplication, or for  
division)  
OK  
6. Enter another number and press  
to display the result.  
END  
7. To close the calculator and return to standby mode, press  
.
Here are a few pointers for using the calculator:  
To change the displayed number from positive (+) to negative (-)  
and vice versa, press  
.
To use the Tip Calculation function, enter an amount and press  
the right softkey button. The calculated tip is displayed. Press  
the right softkey button again to display the total amount  
including the tip.  
To change the tip calculation percentage, press  
, enter a  
OK  
new rate, and press  
.
Tip: Numbers can be input and displayed with up to eight figures, excluding  
decimal points.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2H: Personal Organizer  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2I  
Using Your Phone’s  
Voice Services  
In This Section  
UsingVoice-ActivatedDialing  
VoiceMemos  
his section explains the features associated with your phone’s  
TVoice Services. The easy-to-follow instructions explain how  
to use voice-activated dialing and how to record and manage  
voice memos.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2I: UsingYour Phones Voice Services  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Voice-Activated Dialing  
SM  
In addition to PCS Voice Command (see page 195), you can use a  
Voice Dial tag to automatically dial a phone number in your internal  
Phone Book. Your phone can store up to 100 Voice Dial tags. (To  
create a Voice Dial tag, see “Recording a Voice Dial Tag to Your  
Phone” on page 102.)  
To use a Voice Dial tag to call a phone number:  
TALK  
1. Press and hold  
from standby mode.  
2. Follow the voice prompts and recite the entry’s Voice Dial tag  
into your phone’s microphone. (The number will be dialed  
automatically.)  
Note: Record Voice Dial tags in a quiet environment and without the aid of an  
accessory (for example, a headset).  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2I: UsingYour Phones Voice Services  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording a Voice Dial Tag to Your Phone  
You can set up a voice dial tag for your internal Phone Book entry’s  
phone number in the following two ways.  
To record a voice dial tag and select the phone number:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
3. Highlight VoiceDial and press  
4. Select New (left softkey).  
.
OK  
.
5. After you hear the voice prompt “Name please”, say the name  
you wish to record. (The phone will replay the recording.)  
6. After you hear the voice prompt “Again”, say the name again.  
(The phone will replay the recording and you will hear the  
confirmation, “Entry completed”.)  
OK  
7. Highlight FindName and press  
. (Your internal Phone Book  
list appears.)  
OK  
8. Highlight the desired entry and press  
.
9. Highlight the phone number to which you wish to add the voice  
dial tag and select Save (left softkey). (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
10. Highlight Yes and press  
to save the voice dial tag.  
To select the phone number and record a voice dial tag:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight FindName and press  
. (Your internal Phone Book  
list appears.)  
OK  
4. Highlight the desired entry and press  
.
5. Highlight the phone number to which you wish to add the voice  
dial tag and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
6. Highlight SetVoiceDial and press  
.
7. Follow steps 5 and 6 in “To record a voice dial tag and select the  
phone number” above.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2I: UsingYour Phones Voice Services  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PlayingaVoiceDialTag  
To play a voice dial tag:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
3. Highlight VoiceDial and press  
.
OK  
.
4. Highlight an entry and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Play and press  
(the recorded voice dial tag is  
played).  
ChangingtheVoiceDialTag  
To change the voice dial tag:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
3. Highlight VoiceDial and press  
.
OK  
.
4. Highlight an entry and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Edit and press  
.
6. Follow the voice prompts to record the voice dial tag.  
ErasingaVoiceDialTag  
To erase a voice dial tag from a phone number:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight VoiceDial and press  
.
4. Highlight an entry and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
5. Highlight Erase and press  
. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
6. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2I: UsingYour Phones Voice Services  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Erasing All Voice Dial Tags  
To erase all voice dial tags:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight PhoneBook and press  
3. Highlight VoiceDial and press  
4. Select Options (right softkey).  
.
OK  
.
OK  
5. Highlight EraseAll and press  
. (You will be prompted to  
enter your lock code.)  
6. Enter your lock code. (You will be prompted to confirm.)  
OK  
7. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2I: UsingYour Phones Voice Services  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording Voice Memos  
To record a voice memo in standby mode:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Tools and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight VoiceMemo and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Record and press  
. (The Record screen appears.)  
Shortcut: From standby mode, press and hold VoiceMemo (left softkey) to  
display the Record screen.  
OK  
5. Select Start (left softkey) or press  
6. Start recording after the beep.  
To end the recording of your memo:  
.
OK  
Select Done (left softkey) or press  
.
To record the other party’s voice during a phone call in digital mode:  
1. Press and hold VoiceMemo (left softkey).  
OK  
2. Select Start (left softkey) or press  
.
3. Start recording after the beep.  
To end the recording of the other party’s voice:  
OK  
Select Done (left softkey) or press  
.
Note: Your phone can store 15 memos of 15 seconds each.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2I: UsingYour Phones Voice Services  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing Voice Memos  
To play the voice memo you have recorded:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Tools and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight VoiceMemo and press  
. (The Voice Memo menu  
displays.)  
Shortcut: From standby mode, select VoiceMemo (left softkey) to display the  
Voice Memo menu.  
OK  
4. Highlight Play and press  
. (The voice memo list appears.)  
OK  
5. Highlight a voice memo you wish to play and press  
.
OK  
6. Select Start (left softkey) or press  
to start playing. (To adjust  
volume, press the volume keys on the side of your phone.)  
To end playing:  
OK  
Select Cancel (left softkey) or press  
.
Voice Memo Options  
When the voice memo list displays, following options are available by  
selecting Options (right softkey). To select an option, highlight it and  
OK  
press  
.
Detail to display the date and time.  
Rename to rename the voice memo’s caption. (See “Renaming a  
Voice Memo’s Caption” on page 107.)  
AssignRinger to assign the voice memo’s sound to the ringer tasks.  
(See “Assigning a Voice Memo to Ringer Tasks” on page 107.)  
Erase to erase the voice memo. (See “Erasing a Voice Memo” on  
page 108.)  
EraseAll to erase all the voice memos.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2I: UsingYour Phones Voice Services  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
RenamingaVoiceMemo’sCaption  
To rename a voice memo’s caption:  
1. From standby mode, select VoiceMemo (left softkey).  
OK  
2. Highlight Play and press  
.
3. Highlight the voice memo and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
4. Highlight Rename and press  
.
OK  
5. Edit the voice memo’s caption and press  
.
AssigningaVoiceMemotoRingerTasks  
To assign a voice memo’s sound recorded in standby mode to the  
ringer tasks:  
1. From standby mode, select VoiceMemo (left softkey).  
OK  
2. Highlight Play and press  
. (The voice memo list appears.)  
3. Highlight the desired voice memo and select Options (right  
softkey).  
OK  
4. Highlight AssignRinger and press  
to display options. (If  
you select a voice memo recorded during a call, your phone  
returns to the voice memo list so you may select another one.)  
OK  
5. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
VoiceCalls to assign the voice memo to the voice call ringer.  
Voicemail to assign the voice memo to the voicemail alert.  
TextMsg/Pic. Mail to assign the voice memo to the  
text/picture message alert.  
PhoneBook to assign the voice memo to an internal Phone  
Book entry’s phone number or email address.  
Time to assign the voice memo to Alarm, Countdown, or  
Scheduler.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2I: UsingYour Phones Voice Services  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ErasingaVoiceMemo  
To erase a voice memo:  
1. From standby mode, select VoiceMemo (left softkey).  
OK  
2. Highlight Play and press  
.
3. Highlight the voice memo and select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
4. Highlight Erase and press  
. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
5. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Erasing All Voice Memos  
To erase all voice memos:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Tools and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight VoiceMemo and press  
.
Shortcut: From standby mode, select VoiceMemo (left softkey).  
OK  
4. Highlight EraseAll and press  
. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
5. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2I: UsingYour Phones Voice Services  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2J  
Using Your Phone’s Camera  
With Camcorder  
In This Section  
TakingPictures  
TakingVideos  
SM  
SharingPictureMail  
StoringPictures  
StoringVideos  
SM  
ManagingPictureMail  
our PCS Phone gives you the ability to take full-color digital pictures  
Yand videos, view your pictures and videos using the phone’s display,  
and instantly share them with your family and friends. It’s fun and as  
easy to use as a traditional point-and-click camera – just take a picture,  
view it on your phone’s display, and send it to up to ten people, right  
from your phone. Your pictures and videos may also be uploaded to a  
SM  
Picture Mail Website for storage or sent to another Website for your  
personal use. Picture quality is similar to what you see on your  
computer screen.  
This section explains the features and options of your phone’s  
built-in PCS Vision Camera/Camcorder.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Taking Pictures  
Taking pictures with your phone’s built-in PCS Camera is as simple as  
choosing a subject, pointing the lens, and pressing a button. You can  
activate Camera mode and take pictures whether the phone is open  
or closed.  
To take a picture with the phone open:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight Camera and press  
to activate Camera mode. The  
LED blinks red. (Additionaloptionsareavailablethroughthe  
camera’sOptionsmenu. SeeCameraModeOptions” onpage113for  
moreinformation.)  
Shortcut: To activate Camera mode, you can also press  
twice, or press and  
hold , or just press the Side Camera button (see illustration on page 8).  
4. Using the phone’s main LCD as a viewfinder, aim the camera  
lens at your subject.  
OK  
5. Hold the camera steady. To take the picture, press  
,
,
or the Side Camera button. (The picture will automatically be  
saved and displayed on the screen.)  
6. Select Next (right softkey) to display the following options:  
SendPicture to send the picture to your recipients (see  
“Sharing Picture Mail” on page 118).  
GotoCamera to return to Camera mode to take another  
picture.  
Upload to upload the picture to the Web.  
Erase to erase the picture.  
GotoMyPicture to view your pictures saved in the camera.  
Assign to assign the picture to the phone tasks.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To take a picture with the phone closed:  
1. Press and hold the Side Camera button to activate Camera mode.  
2. Point the camera lens at your subject. You can check the picture  
framing through the sub display screen.  
3. Press the Side Camera button to take the picture.  
Note: Your phone can save up to 30 pictures/videos in the camera/camcorder  
(for example, 20 pictures and 10 videos) regardless of your settings and usage.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SM  
Creating Your Picture Mail Password  
The first time you use any of the Picture Mail management options  
involving the Picture Mail Website you will need to establish a  
Picture Mail password through your PCS Phone. This password  
will also allow you to log in to the Picture Mail Website at  
picturemail.sprintpcs.com to access and manage your uploaded  
pictures and albums.  
To create your Picture Mail password:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyPictures and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight InCamera and press  
.
OK  
5. Select Options(right softkey), highlight Upload, and press  
.
(You will be prompted to enter a password for your account.)  
OK  
6 Select OK (left softkey) or press  
to display the Password  
screen.  
7. Enter a four- to eight-digit, alpha-numeric password and  
OK  
press  
.
OK  
8. Select Save (left softkey) or press  
. (You will be prompted  
to confirm your password.)  
Tip: Write down your Picture Mail password in a secure place.  
9. Please wait while the system creates your account.  
Once you have received confirmation that your account has been  
successfully registered, you may upload and share pictures and  
access the Picture Mail Website.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Camera Mode Options  
When the phone is open and in Camera mode, several options are  
available.  
To select a zoom option (1x or 2x), press the navigation key up or  
down or press the volume keys on the side of your phone. (The  
zoom function is only available in Medium resolution.)  
To select the desired brightness, press the navigation key right  
(increase) or left (decrease).  
To switch to Camcorder mode, press and hold  
.
To display additional options, select Options (right softkey):  
Flash: Select Off, OnThisShot, or AlwaysOn.  
Self-timer: Activate the camera’s timer function. See “Setting the  
Self-timer” on page 115 for details.  
FunFrames: Select your favorite fun picture frame to decorate  
your picture. The fun frame function is only available in Medium  
resolution. (Once you have taken a picture, the fun frame cannot  
be removed from the picture.)  
Zoom: Select 1X or 2X. (The zoom function is only available in  
Medium resolution.)  
Brightness: Press the navigation key right (increase) or left  
OK  
(decrease) to select a setting and press  
to apply the desired  
setting.  
PictureEffects: Select Off, Black&White, Sepia, Watermark, or  
Glitter. The Watermark and Glitter are only available in Medium  
resolution. (Once you have taken a picture, the picture effect  
cannot be removed from the picture.)  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CameraSettings: These settings will remain unchanged, even you  
turn the phone on/off.  
ShutterSound: Select ShutterSound, ClickSound, Beep, Say  
Cheeze!, or Silent. (The shutter does not sound if your  
phone’s Ringer Volume is set to Vib, Off, or SilenceAll.)  
Resolution: Select High (480x640) or Medium (240x320).  
Quality: Select the picture quality Normal or Fine.  
DateStamp: Select On or Off. (The date stamp is only  
available in Medium resolution.)  
MemoryGauge: Select Show or Hide.  
FinderScope: Select Show or Hide.  
GotoCamcorder: Switch to Camcorder mode to take videos.  
Note: After taking a picture, the Self-timer, Fun Frames, and Picture Effects  
settings return to Off.  
Note: Exiting Camera mode resets Flash, Zoom, and Brightness to their default  
settings.  
Brightness adjustment  
Resolution icon*  
Number of stored pictures/videos  
Count of  
pictures/videos  
you can take  
Camera mode icon  
Memory gauge  
Brightness icon  
Zoom icon*  
Fine/Normal icon  
Flash icon  
Self-timer icon  
Zoom adjustment*  
CameraModeDisplay  
Resolution, Zoom, and Zoom adjustment icons are only available in  
Medium resolution.  
*
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SettingtheSelf-timer  
To activate the Self-timer and get yourself in on the picture or video:  
1. With the phone open and in Camera mode, select Options  
(right softkey).  
OK  
2. Highlight Self-timer and press  
.
3. Highlight one of the timer options (2Sec., 5Sec., or 10Sec.) and  
OK  
press  
press  
. To deactivate the Self-timer, highlight Off and  
.
OK  
OK  
4. Press  
when you are ready to start the timer. The phone  
beeps every second. The LED blinks green and turns red for the  
last few seconds.  
5. When the self-timer expires, the phone takes a picture or starts  
recording a video automatically.  
To cancel the Self-timer after it has started:  
Select Cancel (right softkey).  
Note: While the Self-timer is active, all keys are disabled except Back, End, and  
the right softkey (Cancel).  
Note: After taking a picture or video, the Self-timer setting returns to Off.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Taking Videos  
Taking videos with your phone’s built-in PCS Camcorder is as simple  
as choosing a subject, pointing the lens, and pressing a button.  
To take a video:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight Camcorder and press  
to activate Camcorder  
mode. The LED blinks red. (Additional options are available  
through the camcorder’s Options menu. See “Camcorder Mode  
Options” on page 117 for more information.)  
Shortcut: From Camera mode, press and hold  
to switch to Camcorder mode.  
4. Using the phone’s main LCD as a viewfinder, aim the camera  
lens at your subject.  
OK  
5. Select Record (left softkey) or press  
to start recording with  
the camcorder (up to 15 seconds). The LED lights red steadily.  
6. Toendrecording,selectDone (leftsoftkey). (Yourvideowill  
automaticallybesavedandthefirstframefromyourvideoisdisplayed.)  
7. To play the video, select Playback (left softkey) and select Play  
(right softkey).  
8. Select Next (right softkey) to display the following options:  
SendVideo to send the video to your recipients (see  
“Sharing Video Mail From My Video” on page 122).  
GotoCamcorder to return to Camcorder mode to take  
another video.  
Playback to play the video.  
Upload to upload the video to the Web.  
Erase to erase the video.  
GotoMyVideo to view your videos saved in the camcorder.  
Note: Your phone can save up to 30 pictures/videos in the camera/camcorder  
(for example, 20 pictures and 10 videos) regardless of your settings and usage.  
Note: Only the main LCD works as a viewfinder for the camcorder. When the  
phone is closed, the camcorder does not work.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Camcorder Mode Options  
When the phone is open and in Camcorder mode, several options are  
available.  
To switch the video screen between the full-screen view and  
small view, press the navigation key up or down.  
To select a zoom option (1x, 2x, or 4x), press the volume keys on  
the side of your phone.  
To select the desired brightness, press the navigation key right  
(increase) or left (decrease).  
To switch to Camera mode, press and hold  
.
Note: While you are recording a video, these options are not available.  
To display additional options, select Options (right softkey):  
Self-timer: Activate the video’s timer function. See “Setting the  
Self-timer” on page 115 for details.  
MovieLight: Select On or Off.  
Zoom: Select 1X, 2X, or 4X.  
Brightness: Pressthenavigationkeyright(increase)orleft(decrease)  
OK  
toselectasettingandpress  
toapplythedesiredsetting.  
MyVideo: EntertheMyVideo-InCamcordermenutoviewvideoyou  
havetaken(seeViewingVideosinYourCamcorder” onpage130).  
Go to Camera: Switch to Camera mode to take pictures.  
Note: After taking a video, the Self-timer setting returns to Off.  
Note: Exiting Camcorder mode resets MovieLight, Zoom, and Brightness to  
their default settings.  
Standby/Rec/Play  
Brightness icon  
Zoom icon  
Camcorder mode icon  
Movie Light icon  
Self-timer icon  
Progress gauge  
CamcorderModeDisplay  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SM  
Sharing Picture Mail  
Once you’ve taken a picture or video, you can use the messaging  
capabilities of your PCS Phone to instantly share it with family and  
friends. You can send a picture or video to up to ten people at a time  
using their email addresses or their PCS Vision Phone numbers.  
Sharing Picture Mail From My Pictures  
To share Picture Mail from the My Pictures menu:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyPictures and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight InCamera and press  
. (Thumbnail pictures are  
displayed.)  
5. Select the picture you’d like to send and select Send (left softkey).  
6. To enter recipients to the Recipient List, highlight an option  
OK  
from the “Select address from” menu and press  
.
PhoneBookto select recipients from your internal Phone  
Book entries. (See “Selecting Recipients From Your Internal  
Phone Book” on page 120.)  
EnterMobile# to enter a recipient’s PCS Vision Phone number.  
(You will be prompted to save it to your internal Phone Book.)  
EnterEmail to enter a recipient’s email address. (You will be  
prompted to save it to your internal Phone Book.)  
GroupList to select recipients from your Group List. (See  
“Selecting Recipients From Your Group List” on page 120.)  
7. To add more recipients to the Recipient List, select Options (left  
OK  
softkey), highlight AddNewRecipient, and press  
. You can  
repeat step 6 above. To erase a recipient from the Recipient List,  
highlight the recipient, select Options (left softkey), highlight  
OK  
Erase, and press  
.
8. Select Next (right softkey) when you are finished  
selecting/entering recipients. (You may include up to ten  
recipients per Picture Mail.)  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9. If you wish to record and include a Voice Memo with the picture  
you are sending, select Start (left softkey), and start recording  
after the beep. (Maximum recording time is 10 seconds). If you  
do not wish to attach a Voice Memo to the Picture Mail, select  
Skip (right softkey).  
10. Use your keypad to enter a text message (or press the left  
softkey to select from PresetMessages or RecentMessages) and  
OK  
select Next (right softkey) or press  
. (See “Entering Text”  
on page 26.) You may also choose to leave the message area  
OK  
blank; just select Skip (right softkey) or press  
to continue.  
11. In the Preview screen, confirm the recipients, voice memo,  
message, and picture.  
To confirm, change, or add a recipient, highlight the  
recipient, and select Change (right softkey). The Recipient  
List appears. Follow the instructions in step 7 on the  
previous page to select or edit the recipient.  
To confirm or change the voice memo, highlight Voice  
Memo:Recorded, select Change (right softkey). The Play  
Voice Memo screen appears. Select Start (left softkey) to  
play the voice memo; select Options (right softkey) to  
display further options (Play, Re-record, and Erase).  
If you have skipped step 9 above and wish to add a voice  
memo now, highlight AddVoiceMemo and select Add (right  
softkey). The Add Voice Memo screen appears. Follow the  
instructions in step 9.  
To confirm, change, or add a text message, highlight the  
message or AddTextMessage, select Change or Add (right  
softkey). The Message screen appears. Follow the  
instructions in step 10 to edit the text message.  
12. From the Preview screen, select Send (left softkey) to send the  
picture.  
13. Waitforcompletionofthesendingprocess. (Youwillbeprompted,  
OK  
whencompleted.)Press  
tocleartheprompt.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SelectingRecipientsFromYourInternalPhoneBook  
To select Picture Mail recipients from your internal Phone Book:  
1. From the “Select address from” menu, highlight PhoneBook and  
OK  
press  
. (The Find Name screen appears with your internal  
Phone Book list. This list only includes phone numbers you  
labeled as Mobile and email addresses.)  
2. Highlight a recipient’s name and select Select (left softkey) or  
OK  
press  
. (This will check the box next to the recipient. If the  
recipient has two or more addresses, the Details screen appears  
for further selection.)  
From the Details screen, highlight an email address or  
OK  
PCS Vision Phone number and press  
. (Thiswillcheck  
theboxnexttoarecipient’semailaddressorphonenumber.)  
ToreturntotheFindNamescreen, selectDone (rightsoftkey).  
3. To add more recipients, repeat step 2 above.  
4. When you are finished, select Next (right softkey). (You will  
return to the Recipient List with the selected recipients.)  
SelectingRecipientsFromYourGroupList  
To select Picture Mail recipients from your Group List:  
1. From the “Select address from” menu, highlight GroupList and  
OK  
press  
. (Your Group List appears.)  
2. Highlight a recipient’s name and select Check or Uncheck (right  
softkey). (This will check or clear the box next to the recipient’s  
name.) Repeat it for all entries in the group list.  
OK  
3. When you are finished, press  
. (You will return to the  
Recipient List with the selected recipients.)  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phone’s Camera With Camcorder  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sharing Picture Mail From Messaging  
You can also share your pictures from your phone’s Messaging menu.  
To share Picture Mail from the Messaging menu:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Messaging and press  
to access the Messaging  
menu.  
Shortcut: Select Messaging (right softkey) from standby mode to access the  
Messaging menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight Sendmessage and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Send PictureMail and press  
. (Your pictures saved  
in My Pictures - In Camera are displayed in thumbnail view.)  
5. Use the navigation key to display the picture you wish to send  
and select Select (left softkey).  
6. To complete and send the Picture Mail, follow steps 6-13 in  
“Sharing Picture Mail From My Pictures” on page 118.  
Tip: To view incoming Picture Mail message, see Viewing Incoming  
Picture/Video Mail Messageson page 160.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sharing Video Mail From My Video  
To share Video Mail from the My Video menu:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyVideo and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight InCamcorder and press  
. (Video icons are  
displayed.)  
5. Highlight a video icon and select Playback (left softkey) or press  
OK  
. (The first frame from the selected video is displayed.)  
6. Press the navigation key left or right to select the video you'd  
like to send and select Send (left softkey).  
7. To complete and send the video, follow steps 6-13 in “Sharing  
Picture Mail From My Pictures” on page 118. (In the Preview  
screen, a video icon will be displayed in place of a picture.)  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sharing Video Mail From Messaging  
You can also share your video from your phone’s Messaging menu.  
To share Video Mail from the Messaging menu:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Messaging and press  
to access the Messaging  
menu.  
Shortcut: Select Messaging (right softkey) from standby mode to access the  
Messaging menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight Sendmessage and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight SendVideoMail and press  
. (Video icons from My  
Video - In Camcorder are displayed.)  
OK  
5. Highlight a video icon and press  
. (The first frame from the  
selected video is displayed.)  
6. Press the navigation key left or right to select the video you wish  
to send and select Select (left softkey).  
7. To complete and send the Video Mail, follow steps 6-13 in  
“Sharing Picture Mail From My Pictures” on page 118.  
Tip: To view incoming Video Mail message, see Viewing Incoming  
Picture/Video Mail Messageson page 160.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Storing Pictures  
Once a picture is taken, it is automatically saved to your camera.  
From the My Pictures menu you can view all the pictures you have  
taken, store selected images in your phone, send pictures to the Picture  
Mail Website, delete images, and access additional picture options.  
Viewing Pictures in Your Camera  
To view pictures saved in your camera:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
Shortcut: To access the Pictures/Video menu, press  
from standby mode.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyPictures and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight InCamera and press  
. (Thumbnail pictures are  
displayed.)  
5. Use your navigation key to scroll through and view the pictures.  
OK  
6. To expand the selected picture, press  
. (To return to  
BACK  
thumbnail view, press  
.)  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
InCameraOptions  
To display additional options for the selected picture, select Options  
(right softkey) from the thumbnail view or full-screen view. To select  
OK  
an option, highlight it and press  
.
Upload to upload a picture to the Web. (See “Uploading Pictures”  
on page 126.)  
Assign to assign a picture to phone tasks. (See “Assigning Pictures  
to Phone Tasks” on page 128.)  
Erase to erase pictures.  
EditCaption to edit the picture’s caption. (See “Entering Text” on  
page 26.)  
PictureInfo to display information on the selected picture, such as  
caption, time/date, size, etc.  
Expand/Thumbnail to switch the display between thumbnail view  
and full-screen.  
GotoCamerato switch to Camera mode to take pictures.  
Tip: To send the selected picture, select Send (left softkey) from the thumbnail  
view or full-screen view.  
Tip: To switch to Camera mode, press  
from the In Camera menu.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Uploading Pictures  
Touploadpicturesfromyourphone’scameratothePictureMailWebsite:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyPictures and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight InCamera and press  
. (Thumbnail pictures are  
displayed.)  
5. Use your navigation key to select the picture you want to upload.  
6. Select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
7. Highlight Upload and press  
.
OK  
8. Highlight Uploadthis or Uploadall and press  
to upload a  
single picture or all pictures saved in your camera. (Depending  
on your settings, you may be prompted to accept a PCS Vision  
connection.)  
9. Wait for completion of the uploading process. (You will be  
prompted, when completed.)  
OK  
10. Press  
to clear the prompt. (You will be prompted to erase  
the pictures from your camera.)  
OK  
11. Highlight Yes to erase or No to cancel and press  
.
Note: Uploading copies pictures from your phone’s My Pictures to your online  
Picture Mail account. Pictures which have been uploaded to your online account  
will remain available in My Pictures until you erase them.  
Tip: The  
icon will appear on the uploaded pictures.  
Note: If this is the first time you have accessed the Picture Mail account, you will  
be prompted to create your Picture Mail password. See “Creating Your Picture  
Mail Password” on page 158.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phone’s Camera With Camcorder  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Viewing Downloaded Pictures  
To view pictures downloaded from the Picture Mail Website:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyPictures and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Downloaded/Assigned and press  
. (Thumbnail  
pictures are displayed.)  
5. Use your navigation key to scroll through and view the pictures.  
6. To switch the display between full-screen and thumbnail view,  
select Expand or Thumbnail (left softkey).  
7. To display additional options, select Options (right softkey) from  
the thumbnail view:  
Assign to assign a picture to phone tasks. (See “Assigning  
Pictures to Phone Tasks” on page 128.)  
Erase to erase pictures.  
Note: The downloaded/assigned picture's caption will be replaced with date  
and time when the picture was taken.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Assigning Pictures to Phone Tasks  
To assign a picture saved in My Pictures to display for specific tasks:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyPictures and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight InCamera or Downloaded/Assigned and press  
.
(Thumbnail pictures are displayed.)  
5. Use your navigation key to select a desired picture.  
6. Select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
7. Highlight Assign and press  
. (Phone tasks are displayed.)  
8. To assign the selected picture to a specific task, highlight it and  
OK  
press  
:
ScreenSaver to display the picture on the main display as a  
screen saver.  
PhoneBook to display the picture for incoming calls from a  
specific internal Phone Book entry.  
Scheduler to display the picture on a scheduled event.  
SubLCD to display the picture on the sub display.  
MainMenu to display the picture on the main menu.  
MyMenu to display the picture on My Menu.  
Note: A picture may be assigned to more than one task.  
Note: Assigning a picture from the In Camera menu to any of the first four tasks  
copies the picture to the Downloaded/Assigned folder. (The copied picture's  
caption will be replaced with date and time when the picture was taken.)  
Assigning a picture from the In Camera menu to Main Menu or My Menu copies  
the picture to the dedicated folder.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Erasing Pictures  
To erase pictures saved in My Pictures:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyPictures and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight InCamera or Downloaded/Assigned and press  
.
(Thumbnail pictures are displayed.)  
5. Use your navigation key to select a picture.  
6. Select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
7. Highlight Erase and press  
.
OK  
8. Highlight Erasethis or Eraseall and press  
to erase a single  
picture or all pictures saved in the folder. (You will be prompted  
to confirm.)  
OK  
9. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Note: Erasing pictures from the In Camera menu will free up memory space in  
your phone to enable you to take more pictures and videos. Once erased,  
pictures cannot be uploaded to your online Picture Mail account.  
Note: IfyoueraseapictureassignedtoaphonetaskfromtheDownloaded/Assigned  
folder, theerasedpicturewillnolongerbedisplayedfortheassignedtask.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phone’s Camera With Camcorder  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Storing Videos  
Once a video is taken, it is automatically saved to your camcorder.  
From the My Video menu you can view all the videos you have taken,  
store selected images in your phone, send videos to the Picture Mail  
Website, delete images, and access additional video options.  
Viewing Videos in Your Camcorder  
To view a video saved in your camcorder:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyVideo and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight InCamcorder and press  
. (Video icons are  
displayed.)  
5. Highlight a video icon and select Playback (left softkey) or press  
OK  
. (The first frame from the selected video is displayed.)  
To switch the video screen between the full-screen view  
and small view, press the navigation key up or down.  
To select another video, press the navigation key left or right.  
6. To play the video, select Play (right softkey) from the full-screen  
view or small view. (To adjust volume, press the volume keys on  
the side of your phone.)  
BACK  
7. To return to the video icons screen, press  
from the full-  
screen view or small view.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
InCamcorderOptions  
To display additional options from the video icons screen, highlight  
an icon and select Options (right softkey). To select an option,  
OK  
highlight it and press  
.
SendVideo to send a video to your recipients.  
Upload to upload a video to the Web. (See “Uploading Videos” on  
page 132.)  
Erase to erase a video.  
EditCaption to edit the video’s caption. (See “Entering Text” on  
page 26.)  
VideoInfo to display information on the selected video, such as  
caption, time/date, size, etc.  
GotoCamcorder to switch to Camcorder mode to take a video.  
Tip: To switch to Camcorder mode, press  
from the In Camcorder menu.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Uploading Videos  
To upload videos from your phone’s camcorder to the Picture Mail  
Website:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyVideo and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight InCamcorder and press  
. (Video icons are  
displayed.)  
5. Use your navigation key to select the video you want to upload.  
6. Select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
7. Highlight Upload and press  
.
OK  
8. HighlightUploadthis orUploadall andpress  
touploada  
singlevideoorallvideossavedinyourcamcorder. (Dependingon  
yoursettings, youmaybepromptedtoacceptaPCSVision  
connection.)  
9. Wait for completion of the uploading process. (You will be  
prompted, when completed.)  
OK  
10. Press  
to clear the prompt. (You will be prompted to erase  
the video from your camcorder.)  
OK  
11. Highlight Yes to erase or No to cancel and press  
.
Note: Uploading copies videos from your phones My Video to your online  
Picture Mail account. The videos which have been uploaded to your online  
account will remain available in My Video until you erase them.  
Tip: The  
icon will appear on the uploaded video.  
Note: If this is the first time you have accessed the Picture Mail account, you will  
be prompted to create your Picture Mail password. See Creating Your Picture  
Mail Passwordon page 158.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Viewing Downloaded Videos  
To view videos downloaded from the Picture Mail Website:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyVideo and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Downloaded/Saved and press  
. (Video icons are  
displayed.)  
5. Highlight a video icon and select Playback (left softkey) or press  
OK  
. (The first frame from the selected video is displayed.)  
To switch the video screen between the full-screen view  
and small view, press the navigation key up or down.  
To select another video, press the navigation key left or right.  
6. To play the video, select Play (right softkey) from the full-screen  
view or small view. (To adjust volume, press the volume keys on  
the side of your phone.)  
7. To return to the video icons screen, select Thumbnail (left  
BACK  
softkey) or press  
from the full-screen view or small view.  
8. To erase a video from the video icons screen, highlight the  
video icon and select Erase (right softkey).  
Note: The downloaded video's caption will be replaced with date and time when  
the video was recorded.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Erasing Videos  
To erase videos saved in My Video - In Camcorder:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyVideo and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight InCamcorder and press  
. (Video icons are  
displayed.)  
5. Use your navigation key to select a video.  
6. Select Options (right softkey).  
OK  
7. Highlight Erase and press  
.
OK  
8. Highlight Erasethis or Eraseall and press  
to erase a single  
video or all videos saved in the folder. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
9. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Note: Erasing videos from the In Camcorder menu will free up memory space in  
your phone to enable you to take more videos and pictures. Once erased, videos  
cannot be uploaded to your online Picture Mail account.  
To erase videos saved in My Video - Downloaded/Saved:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyVideo and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Downloaded/Saved and press  
. (Video icons are  
displayed.)  
5. Use your navigation key to select a video.  
6. Select Erase (right softkey).  
OK  
7. Highlight Erasethis or Eraseall and press  
to erase a single  
video or all videos saved in the folder. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
8. Highlight Yes and press  
to erase.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing Picture Mail  
Using the Picture Mail Website  
Once you have uploaded pictures or videos from your phone to your  
online Picture Mail account (see “Uploading Pictures” on page 126 or  
“Uploading Videos” on page 132), you can use your personal  
computer to manage your pictures and videos. From the Picture Mail  
Website you can share pictures and videos, edit album titles and  
picture/video captions, organize and move images, and do much more.  
Please visit www.sprintpcs.com for the availability of these services.  
You will also have access to picture management tools to improve  
and customize your pictures. You’ll be able to lighten, darken, crop,  
antique, add comic bubbles and cartoon effects, and use other  
features to transform your pictures.  
To access the Picture Mail Website:  
1. From your computer’s Internet connection, go to  
2. Enter your PCS Phone Number and Picture Mail password to  
register. (See “Creating Your Picture Mail Password” on page 158.)  
Managing Online Picture Mail From Your PCS Phone  
You can use your phone to manage, edit, or share pictures and videos  
you have uploaded to the Picture Mail Website. (See “Uploading  
Pictures” on page 126 and “Uploading Videos” on page 132 for  
information about uploading.)  
To view your online Picture Mail from your PCS Phone:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
.
Shortcut: Instead of steps 1 and 2 above, press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Online Albums and press  
. Depending on your  
settings you may be prompted to accept a PCS Vision connection.  
(The Online Albums menu appears.)  
OK  
4. Highlight Uploads or an album title and press  
.
(Thumbnail pictures and videos, up to nine per screen, are  
displayed.)  
5. Use your navigation key to select a picture or video and  
select View (left softkey) to expand it.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sharing Online Picture Mail  
To share online Picture Mail:  
1. From the Uploads screen or an album screen, select a picture or  
video you wish to share and select Options (right softkey).  
(See “Accessing Online Picture Mail Options From Your PCS  
Phone” on page 138.)  
OK  
2. Highlight SendPicture or SendVideo and press  
.
3. To enter recipients to the Recipient List, highlight an option  
OK  
from the “Select address from” menu and press  
.
PhoneBookto select recipients from your internal Phone  
Book entries. (See “Selecting Recipients From Your Internal  
Phone Book” on page 120.)  
EnterMobile# to enter a recipient’s PCS Vision Phone number.  
(You will be prompted to save it to your internal Phone Book.)  
EnterEmail to enter a recipient’s email address. (You will be  
prompted to save it to your internal Phone Book.)  
GroupList to select recipients from your Group List. (See  
“Selecting Recipients From Your Group List” on page 120.)  
OnlineAddressBk to select recipients from your Online  
Address Book (your sharing history from the Web).  
OK  
Highlight a recipient and press  
. (This will check the  
box next to the recipient.) To clear the box, highlight it and  
OK  
press  
. When you are finished, select Done (left  
softkey). (You will return to the Recipient List with the  
selected recipients.)  
4. To add more recipients to the Recipient List, select Options (left  
OK  
softkey), highlight AddNewRecipient, and press  
. You can  
repeat step 3 above. To erase a recipient from the Recipient List,  
highlight the recipient, select Options (left softkey), highlight  
OK  
Erase, and press  
.
5. SelectNext (rightsoftkey)whenyouarefinishedselecting/entering  
recipients. (Youmayincludeuptotenrecipients.)  
6. If you wish to record and include a Voice Memo with the picture  
or video you are sending, select Start (left softkey), and start  
recording after the beep. (Maximum recording time is 10  
seconds). If you do not wish to attach a Voice Memo to the  
Picture Mail, select Skip (right softkey).  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Use your keypad to enter a text message (or press the left  
softkey to select from PresetMessages or RecentMessages) and  
OK  
select Next (right softkey) or press  
. (See “Entering Text”  
on page 26.) You may also choose to leave the message area  
OK  
blank; just select Skip (right softkey) or press  
to continue.  
8. In the Preview screen, confirm the recipients, voice memo, and  
message.  
To confirm, change, or add a recipient, highlight the  
recipient and select Change (right softkey). The Recipient  
List appears. Follow the instructions in steps 3 and 4 on the  
previous page to select or edit the recipient.  
To confirm or change the voice memo, highlight Voice  
Memo:Recorded, select Change (right softkey). The Play  
Voice Memo screen appears. Select Start (left softkey) to  
play the voice memo; select Options (right softkey) to  
display further options (Play, Re-record, and Erase).  
If you have skipped step 6 on the previous page and wish to  
add a voice memo now, highlight AddVoiceMemo and select  
Add (right softkey). The Add Voice Memo screen appears.  
Follow the instructions in step 6.  
To confirm, change, or add a text message, highlight the  
message or AddTextMessage and select Change or Add (right  
softkey). The Message screen appears. Follow the  
instructions in step 7 to edit the text message.  
9. From the Preview screen, select Send (left softkey) to send the  
picture or video.  
To share an album from online mode:  
1. From the Online Albums menu, select an album you wish to  
share and select Options (right softkey). (See “Accessing Online  
Picture Mail Options From Your PCS Phone” on page 138.)  
OK  
2. Highlight SendAlbum and press  
.
3. Follow steps 3-9 in “Sharing Online Picture Mail” on page 136 to  
complete and send your album. (The Voice Memo option is not  
available for sending an album.)  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phone’s Camera With Camcorder  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessing Online Picture Mail Options From Your PCS Phone  
To access online Picture Mail options from your phone:  
1. Select a picture or video from the Uploads screen or an album  
screen (see “Managing Online Picture Mail From Your PCS  
Phone” on page 135).  
2. Select Options (right softkey) to display options.  
OK  
3. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
SendPicture or SendVideo to share a picture or video  
through the Picture Mail Website. (See “Sharing Online  
Picture Mail” on page 136.)  
Copy/Move to copy or move pictures or video to a  
selected album:  
Copythis tocopytheselectedpictureorvideotothealbum.  
Copyall to copy all pictures and videos in the current  
album (or Uploads) to the target album.  
Movethis to move the selected picture or video  
to the album.  
Moveall to move all pictures and videos in the current  
album (or Uploads) to the target album.  
Download to copy the selected picture or video to your  
phone’s My Picture or My Video.  
MediaView to switch the display mode for the current  
album (or Uploads). Select PicturesOnly or VideoOnly to  
display either pictures or videos; select AllMedia to display  
both pictures and videos. (The Media View option appears  
when the album includes both pictures and videos.)  
Erase to select Erasethis or Eraseall to erase a single  
picture/video or all pictures/videos saved in the current  
album (or Uploads).  
EditCaption to edit the picture’s or video’s caption.  
RotatePicture to rotate the selected picture. (This option is  
only available for pictures.)  
CreateAlbum to create a new album. Enter the album name  
OK  
and press  
.
OnlineAlbumsto switch from pictures or videos to the  
album list.  
PictureInfo or VideoInfo to display information on the  
selected picture or video, such as title, time/date, size, etc.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To access your online Albums options from your PCS Phone:  
1. Display the album list in the Online Albums menu.  
2. Use your navigation key to select an album (or Uploads).  
3. Select Options (right softkey) to display options.  
OK  
4. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
Send Album to share the album through the Picture Mail  
Website. (See “Sharing Online Picture Mail” on page 136.)  
CreateAlbum to create a new album. Enter a new album  
OK  
name and press  
.
EraseAlbum to delete the selected album.  
Rename Album to rename the selected album. Enter a new  
OK  
name and press  
.
AlbumInfo to display information on the selected album,  
such as title, time/date, and number of files.  
Note:The Uploads folder cannot be erased or renamed.  
Section 2: Understanding Your PCS Phone  
2J: UsingYour Phones Camera With Camcorder  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3  
Using  
PCS Service Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3A  
PCS Service Features:  
The Basics  
In This Section  
UsingVoicemail  
UsingCallerID  
RespondingtoCallWaiting  
MakingaThree-WayCall  
UsingCallForwarding  
ow that you’ve mastered your phone’s fundamentals, it’s time to  
Nexplore the calling features that enhance your PCS Service.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3A: PCS Service Features The Basics  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Voicemail  
Setting Up Your Voicemail  
All unanswered calls to your PCS Phone are automatically transferred  
to voicemail, even if your phone is in use or turned off. Therefore,  
you will want to set up your PCS Voicemail and personal greeting as  
soon as your PCS Phone is activated.  
To set up voicemail:  
1
1. Press and hold  
.
2. Follow the system prompts to create your pass code, record  
your greeting, record your name announcement, and choose  
whether to activate One-Touch Message Access (a feature that  
lets you press one key to access messages and bypasses the  
need for you to enter your pass code).  
Note: The voicemail setup process may vary in certain Affiliate areas.  
Voicemail Notification  
There are several ways your PCS Phone alerts you:  
By displaying a message on the screen.  
By sounding the assigned ringer type.  
By the LED blinking red.  
By displaying  
at the top of your screen. (This icon blinks for  
an urgent message.)  
New Voicemail Message Alerts  
When you receive a new voice message, your phone alerts you and  
prompts you to call your voicemail. To call your voicemail, select Call  
OK  
TALK  
(left softkey), select Voicemail, and press  
or  
.
Important: When you are roaming off the enhanced Sprint Nationwide  
PCS Network, you may not receive notification of new voicemail messages. It is  
recommended that you periodically check your voicemail by dialing 1 + area  
code + your PCS Phone Number. When your voicemail answers, press  
enter your pass code. You will be charged roaming rates when accessing  
voicemail while roaming off the enhanced Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.  
and  
Note: Your phone accepts messages even when it is turned off. However, you are  
only notified of new messages when your phone is turned on and you are in a  
PCS Service Area.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3A: PCS Service Features The Basics  
142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Retrieving Your Voicemail Messages  
You can review your messages directly from your PCS Phone or from  
any other touch-tone phone. To dial from your PCS Phone, you can  
either speed dial your voicemail or use the menu keys.  
UsingOne-TouchMessageAccess  
1
Press and hold  
. Follow the system prompts.  
UsingtheMenuKeysonYourPCSPhonetoAccessYourMessages  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Voicemail and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight CallVoicemail and press  
.
Note: You are charged for airtime minutes when you are accessing your  
voicemail from your PCS Phone.  
UsingaPhoneOtherThanYourPCSPhonetoAccessMessages  
1. Dial your PCS Phone Number.  
2. When your voicemail answers, press  
.
3. Enter your pass code.  
Tip: When you call into voicemail you first hear the header information (date,  
time, and sender information) for the message. To skip directly to the message,  
4
press  
during the header.  
VoicemailButtonGuide  
Here’s a quick guide to your keypad functions while listening to  
voicemail messages. For further details and menu options, see  
“Voicemail Menu Key” on page 147.  
1
2
3
Date/Time Send Reply Advance  
5
6
4
Replay  
Rewind  
Forward  
7
8
9
Erase  
Call Back  
Save  
#
0
Cancel  
Help  
Skip  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3A: PCS Service Features The Basics  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voicemail Options  
Your PCS Phone offers several options for organizing and accessing  
your voicemail.  
UsingExpertMode  
Using the Expert Mode setting for your personal voicemail box helps  
you navigate through the voicemail system more quickly by  
shortening the voice prompts you hear at each level.  
To turn Expert Mode on or off:  
1
1. Press and hold  
to access your voicemail. If your voicemail  
box contains any new or saved messages, press  
to access  
the main voicemail menu.  
3
2. Following the system prompts, press  
to change your  
Personal Options.  
4
3. Press  
for Expert Mode.  
1
4. Press  
to turn Expert Mode on or off.  
SettingUpGroupDistributionLists  
Create up to 20 separate group lists, each with up to 20 customers.  
1
1. Press and hold  
to access your voicemail. If your voicemail  
box contains any new or saved messages, press  
the main voicemail menu.  
to access  
3
2. Following the system prompts, press  
to change your  
Personal Options.  
2
3. Press  
for Administrative Options.  
for Group Distribution Lists.  
5
4. Press  
5. Follow the voice prompts to create, edit, rename, or delete  
group lists.  
PCSCallback  
Return a call after listening to a message without disconnecting  
from voicemail.  
8
1. After listening to a message, press  
.
2. Once the call is complete, you’re returned to the voicemail  
main menu.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3A: PCS Service Features The Basics  
144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voicemail-to-VoicemailMessage  
Record and send a voice message to other PCS Voicemail users.  
2
1. From the main voicemail menu, press  
to send a message.  
2. Follow the voice prompts to enter the phone number.  
3. Follow the voice prompts to record and send your voice  
message.  
Voicemail-to-VoicemailMessageReply  
Reply to a voice message received from any other PCS Voicemail user.  
2
1. After listening to a voice message, press  
.
2. Follow the voice prompts to record and send your reply.  
Voicemail-to-VoicemailMessageForwarding  
Forward a voice message, except those marked “Private,” to other  
PCS Voicemail users.  
6
1. After listening to a message, press  
.
2. Follow the voice prompts to enter the phone number.  
3. Follow the voice prompts to record your introduction and  
forward the voice message.  
Voicemail-to-VoicemailReceiptRequest  
Receive confirmation that your voice message has been  
listened to when you send, forward, or reply to other PCS users.  
1
1. After you have recorded a message, press  
to indicate  
you are satisfied with the message you recorded.  
4
2. Press  
3. Press  
to mark receipt requested.  
1
to send your voicemail message.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3A: PCS Service Features The Basics  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ContinueRecording  
1
Before pressing  
to indicate you are satisfied with the  
4
message you recorded, press  
to continue recording.  
ExtendedAbsenceGreeting  
When your phone is turned off or you are off the enhanced Sprint  
Nationwide PCS Network for an extended period, this greeting can  
be played instead of your normal personal greeting.  
3
1. From the main voicemail menu, press  
for Personal Options.  
3
2. Press  
for Greetings.  
to record an Extended Absence Greeting.  
3
3. Press  
Clearing the Message Icon  
Your phone may temporarily continue to display the message icon  
after you have checked your voice and text messages.  
To clear the icon from the display screen:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Voicemail and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight ClearIcon and press  
. (You will be prompted to  
confirm.)  
OK  
4. Highlight Yes and press  
to clear the icon.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3A: PCS Service Features The Basics  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voicemail Menu Key  
1
Listen  
1
Envelope Information  
2
3
Reply  
Advance 8 Seconds  
Replay  
4
5
Rewind  
6
7
8
9
Forward Message  
Erase  
Callback  
Save  
0
Options  
2
3
Send a Message  
Personal Options  
1
Notification Options  
1
Phone Notification  
2
Numeric Paging to a PCS Phone  
Return to Personal Options Menu  
2
Administrative Options  
1
Skip Pass code  
2
Autoplay  
3
Message Date & Time On/Off  
4
Change Pass code  
5
Group Distribution List  
Return to Personal Options Menu  
Greetings  
3
1
Personal Greetings  
2
Name Announcement  
3
Extended Absence Greeting  
Return to Personal Options Menu  
4
Expert Mode  
On/Off  
8
Place a Call  
Disconnect  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3A: PCS Service Features The Basics  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Caller ID  
Caller ID lets people know who’s calling by displaying the number of  
the person calling.  
To block your phone number from being displayed for a specific  
outgoing call:  
6
7
1. Press  
.
2. Enter the number you want to call.  
TALK  
3. Press  
.
To permanently block your number, call PCS Customer Solutions.  
Responding to Call Waiting  
When you’re on a call, Call Waiting alerts you to incoming calls by  
sounding a beep. Your phone’s screen informs you that another call is  
coming in and displays the caller’s phone number (if it is available  
and you are in digital mode).  
To respond to an incoming call while you’re on a call:  
TALK  
Press  
. (This puts the first caller on hold and answers the  
second call.)  
To switch back to the first caller:  
TALK  
Press  
again.  
Tip: For those calls where you dont want to be interrupted, you can temporarily  
7
0
disable Call Waiting by pressing  
before placing your call. Call  
Waiting is automatically reactivated once you end the call.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3A: PCS Service Features The Basics  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Making a Three-Way Call  
With Three-Way Calling, you can talk to two people at the same time.  
When using this feature, the normal airtime rates will be charged for  
each of the two calls.  
To place a Three-Way Call:  
TALK  
1. Enter a number you wish to call and press  
.
TALK  
2. Once you have established the connection, press  
, highlight 3-WayCall, and press  
on hold.  
(or press  
MENU  
OK  
) to put the first caller  
TALK  
3. Enter the second number you wish to call and press  
(or  
).  
OK  
select Options (right softkey), highlight Call, and press  
TALK  
4. When you’re connected to the second party, press  
again  
MENU  
OK  
(or press  
, highlight Flash, and press  
) to begin your  
three-way call.  
If one of the people you called hangs up during your call, you and the  
remaining caller stay connected. If you initiated the call and are the  
first to hang up, all three callers are disconnected.  
Tip: In step 3 above, you can also call a phone number stored in your internal  
MENU  
Phone Book or Call History. To access these menus, press  
, highlight  
OK  
Phone Book or Call History, and press  
. To call the third party, highlight the  
TALK  
number and press  
.
Note: Call Waiting and Three-Way Calling are not available while roaming off the  
enhanced Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3A: PCS Service Features The Basics  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Call Forwarding  
Call Forwarding lets you forward all your incoming calls to another  
phone number – even when your phone is turned off. You can  
continue to make calls from your phone when Call Forwarding is  
activated.  
To activate Call Forwarding:  
7
2
1. Press  
.
2. Enter the area code and phone number to which incoming calls  
should be forwarded.  
TALK  
3. Press  
. You will hear a tone to confirm the activation of Call  
Forwarding.  
To deactivate Call Forwarding:  
7
2
0
1. Press  
.
TALK  
2. Press  
. You will hear a tone to confirm the deactivation.  
Note: You are charged a higher rate for calls you have forwarded.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3A: PCS Service Features The Basics  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3B  
SM  
PCS Vision  
In This Section  
GettingStarted  
SM  
Picture Mail  
Messaging  
Games  
Ringers  
ScreenSavers  
Web  
SM  
PCSBusinessConnection  
SM  
CS Vision brings you clarity you can see and hear with advanced  
Pmultimedia services. These features, including Picture Mail,  
PCS Mail and PCS Short Mail, chat, games, downloadable ringers and  
SM  
screen savers, Web access, and PCS Business Connection , are easy to  
learn and use and the rich, colorful graphic experience is visually  
comparable to your home or office computer. Clearly, it’s a whole new  
way to look at wireless.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting Started With PCS Vision  
With your PCS Vision Phone and PCS Service, you are ready to start  
enjoying the advantages of PCS Vision. This section will help you  
learn the basics of using your PCS Vision services, including  
managing your User Name, launching a Vision connection, and  
navigating the Web with your PCS Vision Phone.  
Your User Name  
When you buy a PCS Vision Phone and sign up for service, you're  
automatically assigned a User Name. Then, when you use  
PCS Vision services, your User Name is submitted to identify you to  
the enhanced Sprint Nationwide PCS Network. The User Name is  
also useful as an address for PCS Mail, as a way to personalize Web  
services, and as an online virtual identity.  
A User Name is typically based on your name and a number, followed  
by “@sprintpcs.com.” For example, the third John Smith to sign up  
for PCS Vision services might have [email protected] as his User  
Name. If you want a particular User Name, you can visit  
www.sprintpcs.com and get the name you want – as long as nobody  
else has it.  
Note: If you already have a PCS Mail User Name, that will automatically become  
your PCS Vision User Name.  
Your User Name will be automatically programmed into your  
PCS Phone. You don't have to enter it.  
FindingYourUserName  
If you aren't sure what your PCS Vision User Name is, you can easily  
find it online or on your PCS Phone:  
Atwww.sprintpcs.com: Sign on to your account using your  
PCS Phone Number and password. Your User Name appears in  
My Personal Information.  
OnyourPCSPhone: Your User Name can be found through your  
phone’s main menu: Settings > Information > PhoneInfo.  
(When you have a PCS Vision connection.)  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Launching a PCS Vision Connection  
To launch a PCS Vision connection:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Web and press  
.Your PCS Vision connection will  
launch and the PCS Vision Home page will display.  
The PCS Vision Home Page  
This is subject to change.  
Shortcut: You can also press the navigation key left (Web) from standby mode to  
launch the Web.  
Note: If Net Guard is enabled and displayed (see page 154), select OK (left  
softkey) to continue and launch the Web.  
While connecting, the following will appear on the screen:  
Connecting....  
If you had a previous PCS Vision connection, the last page you visited  
will display when you launch your browser, for example, PCS Short  
Mail or ESPN Top News. When this occurs, you may not see the  
“Connecting ...” message when you launch the session. Though the  
browser is open, you are not currently in an active data session - that  
is, no data is being sent or received. As soon as you navigate to  
another page, the active session will launch and you will see the  
“Connecting ...” message.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Net Guard  
When you first connect to the Web, the Net Guard will appear to  
confirm that you want to connect. This feature helps you avoid  
accidental connections. You can disable the Net Guard in the future  
by selecting AlwaysAuto-Connect when the Net Guard is displayed.  
To change your Net Guard settings:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
3. Highlight PCSVision and press  
4. Highlight NetGuard and press  
.
OK  
.
OK  
.
OK  
5. Highlight On or Off and press  
.
Onto activate the Net Guard.  
Off to deactivate the Net Guard.  
Note: When enabled, the Net Guard appears only once per session. The Net  
Guard does not appear if the phone is merely re-connecting due to a time-out.  
PCS Vision Connection Status and Indicators  
Your phone's display lets you know the current status of your  
PCS Vision connection through indicators which appear at the top  
of the screen. The following symbols are used:  
Your PCS Vision connection is active (data is being transferred).  
Incoming voice calls go directly to voicemail; outgoing voice  
calls can be made, but the PCS Vision connection will terminate.  
Your PCS Vision connection is dormant (no data is being sent  
or received). Though not currently active, when dormant the  
phone can restart an active connection quickly; voice calls can  
be made and received.  
Your phone is not currently able to access PCS Vision service  
features.  
If no indicator appears, your phone does not have a current  
PCS Vision connection. To launch a connection, see “Launching a  
PCS Vision Connection” on page 153.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Signing In and Out of PCS Vision Services  
You can sign out of PCS Vision services without turning off your  
phone; however you will not have access to all PCS Vision services,  
including Web and messaging. Signing out will avoid any charges  
associated with PCS Vision services. While signed out, you can still  
place or receive phone calls, check voicemail, and use other voice  
services. You may sign in again at any time.  
To sign out of PCS Vision services:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight PCSVision and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight DisablePCSVision and press  
. (A message will  
appear.)  
5. Select OK (right softkey) to confirm that you want to sign out.  
To sign in to PCS Vision services:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight PCSVision and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight EnablePCSVision and press  
. (The Net Guard will  
appear, if enabled.)  
Updating Your Vision Profile  
If you have changed the programmed User Name into a new one, you  
have to update the Vision Profile in your PCS Phone by following  
these steps:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Settings and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight PCSVision and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight UpdateProfile and press  
. (You will be prompted  
to confirm.)  
OK  
5. Highlight Yes and press  
to proceed. (When completed,  
the phone will return to the PCS Vision menu.)  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Navigating the Web  
Navigating through menus and Websites during a PCS Vision  
session is easy once you've learned a few basics. Here are some tips  
for getting around:  
Softkeys  
During a PCS Vision session, the bottom line of your phone's display  
contains one or more softkey labels. These keys are shortcut controls  
for navigating around the Web, and they correspond to the softkeys  
directly below the phone’s display screen. Depending on which  
Websites you visit, the softkey labels may change to indicate their  
function.  
To use softkeys, simply press the desired softkey. If an additional pop-  
up menu appears when you press the softkey, select the menu items  
using your keypad (if they’re numbered) or by highlighting the  
OK  
option and pressing  
.
Scrolling  
As with other parts of your phone's menu, you'll have to scroll up and  
down to see everything on some Websites.  
Press the navigation key up and down to scroll line by line or  
press the volume buttons on the side of the phone to scroll one  
page at a time.  
Tip: If sound is available from the Web page you are viewing, press the volume  
buttons on the side of the phone to adjust the volume.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting  
Once you've learned how to use softkeys and scroll, you can start  
navigating Websites.  
Select on-screen items by using the navigation key to highlight the  
OK  
desired item, then press the desired softkey button (or press  
).  
You'll find that the left softkey is used primarily for selecting items.  
This softkey is often labeled “OK” or “Select.”  
If the items on a page are numbered, you can use your keypad  
(number keys) to select an item.  
Links, which appear as underlined text, allow you to jump to  
different Web pages, select special functions, or even place  
phone calls.  
Select links by highlighting the link and then selecting the  
appropriate softkey.  
Tip: The tenth item in a numbered list may be selected by pressing  
0
the  
key on your phones keypad, even though the number 0 doesnt appear  
on the screen.  
GoingBack  
BACK  
To go back one page, press the  
key on your phone. (Note  
key is also used for deleting text (like a  
BACKSPACE key) when you are entering text.)  
BACK  
that the  
GoingHome  
To return to the PCS Vision Home Page from any other Web  
BACK  
page, press and hold  
.
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SM  
Picture Mail  
Your phone gives you the ability to take pictures and videos, view them  
using the phone's display, and instantly send them to your friends and  
family. It's as easy to use as a traditional point-and-click camera.  
In addition to sending your pictures and videos to friends and family,  
you can also send them to a Picture Mail Website for storage or upload  
them to a personal Website. Cameras can take and store pictures and  
the image quality is similar to what you see on your computer screen.  
Please visit www.sprintpcs.com for the availability of these services.  
Taking Pictures and Videos  
To take pictures with the built-in Camera:  
See “Taking Pictures” on page 110.  
To take videos with the built-in Camcorder:  
See “Taking Videos” on page 116.  
Sharing Picture/Video Mail From Your PCS Phone  
CreatingYourPictureMailPassword  
The first time you use any of the Picture Mail management options  
involving the Picture Mail Website you will need to establish a  
password through your PCS Phone. This password will also allow  
you to log in to the Picture Mail Website at picturemail.sprintpcs.com  
to access and manage your uploaded pictures.  
To create your password:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Pictures/Video and press  
to access the  
Pictures/Video menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight MyPictures and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight InCamera and press  
.
OK  
5. Select Options (right softkey), highlight Upload, and press  
.
(You will be prompted to create your account password.)  
OK  
Shortcut: From step 3 above, highlight Online Albums and press  
.
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
158  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OK  
6. Select OK (left softkey) or press  
to display the Password  
screen.  
7. Enter a four- to eight-digit, alpha-numeric password and  
OK  
press  
.
OK  
8. SelectSave (leftsoftkey)orpress  
. (You will be prompted to  
confirm your password.)  
Tip: Write down your Picture Mail password in a secure place.  
9. Please wait while the system creates your account.  
Once you have received confirmation that your account has been  
successfully registered you may upload and share pictures and access  
the Picture Mail Website.  
SendingPicture/VideoMailtoOthersFromYourPCSPhone  
To send Picture/Video Mail from your phone:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. HighlightMessaging andpress  
toaccesstheMessagingmenu.  
OK  
3. Highlight Sendmessage and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight SendPictureMailorSendVideoMail and press  
.
5. From the In Camera or In Camcorder screen, select the desired  
picture or video and select Select (left softkey).  
6. Enter a recipient’s email address or PCS Vision Phone number,  
or retrieve the information from your internal Phone Book or  
Group List. Add up to 10 recipients.  
7. SelectNext (rightsoftkey)whenyouarefinishedaddingrecipients.  
8. AddavoicememotothePictureMailorVideoMail.  
9. Add a text message to the Picture Mail or Video Mail and select  
OK  
Next (right softkey) or press  
.
10. Select Send (left softkey) to send the Picture Mail or Video Mail.  
Tip: For complete instructions on sending Picture/Video Mail, see “Sharing  
Picture Mail” on page 118.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
New Picture/Video Mail Message Notifications  
There are several ways your PCS Vision Phone alerts you of incoming  
Picture/Video Mail messages:  
By displaying a message on the screen.  
By sounding the assigned ringer type.  
By the LED blinking red.  
By displaying  
at the top of your screen.  
Viewing Incoming Picture/Video Mail Messages  
To display incoming Picture/Video Mail messages:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Messaging and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight PictureMail and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Inbox and press  
. (A list of Picture/Video Mail  
messages will display.)  
OK  
5. Highlight the message you want to view and press  
to  
display the notification.  
6. To display the picture or video, select Go (left softkey).  
(Your phone will access the Picture Mail Website to display the  
selected Picture/Video Mail message.)  
Icons  
New message  
Read message  
Locked message  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PictureMailInboxOptions  
When the message list or an individual message is displayed in your  
Picture Mail Inbox, select Options (right softkey) to display the  
following options. To select an option, highlight it and press  
OK  
.
Go to go to the Web page to view a picture or video.  
Call to display the sender's phone number. To dial the number,  
TALK  
OK  
press  
or  
Lock/Unlock to lock or unlock the message. (Locked messages are  
marked with and prevented from automatic deleting.)  
.
SavetoP-Book to save the sender’s phone number to your internal  
Phone Book or Group List.  
SavePresetMsg. to save a part of the message as a preset message  
OK  
by selecting Start and End (left softkey) and pressing  
. (This  
option appears only on individual messages.) See "Message  
Options" on page 165.  
Information to display the sender's information.  
ListMode toselectadisplayformat(1Line,2Lines, or3Lines per  
message)forallthemessagelistsincludingInbox, Outbox, and  
PictureMailInbox. (Thisoptionappearsonlyonthemessagelist.)  
Erase to erase the message.  
Memory to display the inbox memory status. (This option appears  
only on the message list.)  
Erasing Picture/Video Mail Messages  
To erase incoming Picture/Video Mail messages:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Messaging and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight PictureMail and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Erase and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight AllMsgs., AllUnread, or AllRead and press  
.
6. When a prompt appears, highlight Yes to erase or No to cancel  
OK  
and press  
.
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessing the Picture Mail Website From Your Computer  
(You will first need to register through your PCS Phone to view  
the Picture Mail Website; see “Creating Your Picture Mail  
Password” on page 158.)  
Fromthe Website, you cansharepicturesandvideo, editalbumtitles  
andpicture/videocaptions, organizeandmoveimages, and muchmore.  
Picture management tools are also available to improve or customize  
your pictures. You'll be able to lighten, darken, crop, antique, add  
comic bubbles and cartoon effects, and use other features to  
transform your pictures.  
Note: A monthly charge will apply for your use of Picture Mail services.  
See your PCS Service Plan for details.  
Tip: For complete details on using your phone's camera and camcorder and the  
Picture Mail service, see Section 2J: Using Your Phone's Camera With  
Camcorder beginning on page 109.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
162  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Messaging  
Now you can send and receive email and text messages and  
participate in Web-based chatrooms right from your PCS Phone.  
Messaging allows you to stay connected to friends, family, and  
co-workers 24 hours a day with always-on text capabilities anywhere  
on the enhanced Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.  
Message Types  
There are many types of text messaging available on your phone.  
These include numeric messages (pages), Messages, Updates, and Mail.  
(PCS Voicemail provides voicemail-to-mailbox messaging. For  
information on using your phone’s voicemail feature, see  
“Using Voicemail” on page 142.)  
Accessing the Messaging Menu  
MENU  
To access the Messaging menu, press  
press  
, highlight Messaging, and  
OK  
OK  
. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
Sendmessage to send Picture Mail (page 158), Video Mail (page  
158), Text Message (page164), or Email for PCS Mail (page 173).  
PictureMail to view incoming Picture/Video Mail (page 160).  
TextMsg. to send and receive Text Messages (page 164).  
Email to access PCS Mail (page 173).  
Voicemail to access Voicemail (page 143).  
Shortcut: From standby mode, select Messaging (right softkey) to access the  
Messaging menu.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Text Messages  
With Text Messages (or SMS messages), you can send text messages  
from your PCS Vision Phone to up to ten recipients of messaging-  
ready mobile phones and email addresses – and they can send  
messages to you. Please visit www.sprintpcs.com for the availability of  
these services.  
Sending a Text Message  
To send a text message from your PCS Vision Phone:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Messaging and press  
.
Shortcut: From standby mode, select Messaging (right softkey) to access the  
Messaging menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight TextMsg. and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Sendmessage and press  
.
5. To enter recipients to the Recipient List, highlight an option  
OK  
from the “Select address from” menu and press  
.
PhoneBook to select recipients from your internal Phone  
Book entries. (See “Selecting Recipients From Your Internal  
Phone Book” on page 120.)  
EnterMobile# to enter a recipient’s mobile phone number.  
(You will be prompted to save it to your internal Phone Book.)  
EnterEmail to enter a recipient’s email address. (You will be  
prompted to save it to your internal Phone Book.)  
GroupList to select recipients from your Group List. (See  
“Selecting Recipients From Your Group List” on page 120.)  
6. To add more recipients to the Recipient List, select Options (left  
OK  
softkey), highlight AddNewRecipient, and press  
. You can  
repeat step 5 above. To erase a recipient from the Recipient List,  
highlight the recipient, select Options (left softkey), highlight  
OK  
Erase, and press  
.
7. Select Next (right softkey) when you are finished  
selecting/entering recipients. (You may include up to ten  
recipients per message.)  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
164  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8. In the Message screen, use your keypad to enter a text message  
(or press the left softkey to select from PresetMessages) and  
OK  
press  
. (See “Entering Text” on page 26.)  
9. In the Sending Options screen, you can select various options to  
your message. (See “Message Options” below.)  
10. To send the message, select Send (left softkey).  
Note: If you attempt to send a text message in analog mode or no service, the  
message cannot be sent and you will be prompted to confirm that you would like  
to send the message when the digital service is available. Select Yes to save the  
message as a Pending message to your outbox; select No to save the message  
as a Canceled message.  
MessageOptions  
The Sending Options screen displays the following options for your  
OK  
message. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
EditRecipientList to add or change the recipients.  
EditMessage to change your text message.  
Priority to select the message priority Normal or Urgent.  
InsertSignature to insert your signature that you preset (see  
“Setting Up for the Messaging” on page 171).  
CallbackNumber to select On (adding your default callback  
number to the message) or Off. You may also edit it by selecting  
Edit (right softkey) to apply only to the current message. (See  
“Setting Up for the Messaging” on page 171.)  
SaveMessage to save your message to your Outbox without  
sending it. (This will exit the Messaging menu and return to  
standby mode.)  
SavetoPresetMsg. to save a part of your message as a preset  
message. Use your navigation key to place the cursor where you  
would like to begin saving the message, select Start (left softkey),  
use your navigation key to highlight the section of the message  
you want to save, select End (left softkey) when you're finished,  
OK  
and press  
to save the selected passage.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
New Message Notifications  
There are several ways your PCS Vision Phone alerts you of incoming  
Text messages:  
By displaying a message on the screen.  
By sounding the assigned ringer type.  
By the LED blinking red.  
By displaying  
at the top of your screen. (This icon blinks for  
an urgent message.)  
Checking Incoming Text Messages  
To check your inbox for incoming text messages:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Messaging and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight TextMsg. and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Inbox and press  
. (A list of messages will display.)  
OK  
5. Highlight the message you want to view and press  
.
Icons  
New message  
Read message  
Urgent New message  
Urgent Read message  
Locked message  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
166  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
InboxOptions  
When the message list or an individual message is displayed in your  
Inbox, select Options (right softkey) to display the following options.  
OK  
To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
Go to go to the Web page specified by a URL from the message (if  
available).  
Call to display the sender’s phone number or ones contained in  
the message (if available). To dial the number, select it and press  
TALK  
OK  
or  
.
Reply to reply to the message (select ReplyNew or Replyw/Copy).  
Forward to forward the message.  
Lock/Unlock to lock or unlock the message. (Locked messages are  
marked with  
and prevented from automatic deleting.)  
SavetoP-Book tosavephonenumbers, emailaddresses, andaURL  
containedinthemessagetoyourinternalPhoneBookorGroupList.  
SavePresetMsg. to save a part of the message as a preset message  
OK  
by selecting Start and End (left softkey) and pressing  
. (This  
option appears only on individual messages.) See “Message  
Options” on page 165.  
Information to display the sender’s information.  
ListMode toselectadisplayformat(1Line,2Lines, or3Lines per  
message)forallthemessagelistsincludingInbox, Outbox, and  
PictureMailInbox. (Thisoptionappearsonlyonthemessagelist.)  
Erase to erase the message.  
Memory to display the inbox memory status. (This option appears  
only on the message list.)  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reviewing Outgoing Text Messages  
To display outgoing text messages stored in the Outbox:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Messaging and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight TextMsg. and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Outbox and press  
. (A list of messages will display.)  
OK  
5. Highlight the message you want to view and press  
.
Icons  
Message sent to the system  
Message failed or canceled  
Message pending (This will automatically be sent when the  
digital service is available.)  
Message saved as draft  
Urgent message  
Locked message  
Message to multiple addresses  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
168  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OutboxOptions  
When the message list or an individual message is displayed in your  
Outbox, select Options (right softkey) to display the following  
OK  
options. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
Go to go to the Web page specified by a URL from the message (if  
available).  
Call to display the recipient’s phone number or ones contained in  
the message (if available). To dial the number, select it and press  
TALK  
OK  
or  
.
Forward to forward the message.  
Edit to edit and send the message.  
Send to send the message.  
Lock/Unlock to lock or unlock the message. (Locked messages are  
marked with  
and prevented from automatic deleting.)  
ComposeNew to compose a new message.  
Information to display information about the message.  
ListMode toselectadisplayformat(1Line,2Lines, or3Lines per  
message)forallthemessagelistsincludingInbox, Outbox, and  
PictureMailInbox. (Thisoptionappearsonlyonthemessagelist.)  
Erase to erase the message.  
Memory to display the outbox memory status. (This option  
appears only on the message list.)  
StatusCode to display the time stamp and message ID. (This  
option appears only on the individual message.)  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Erasing All Text Message  
s
To erase all text messages from your inbox and outbox  
:
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Messaging and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight TextMsg. and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight Erase and press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight Inbox, Outbox, or All and press  
.
Inbox to select from further options (AllMsgs., AllUnread, or  
AllRead) to erase text messages from the inbox.  
Outbox to erase all text messages from the outbox.  
All to erase all text messages from both inbox and outbox.  
6. When a prompt appears, highlight Yes to erase or No to cancel  
OK  
and press  
.
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up for Messaging  
There are several messaging menu options available from your  
phone's menus by selecting Settings and selecting Messaging. To  
OK  
select a menu option, highlight it and press  
. These settings will  
be applied to Text messages and Picture/Video Mail messages.  
DisplayPop-up: Select On (to display new incoming  
text/picture/video message content automatically) or Off.  
SaveSentMessage: Select from AutoSave (to save all the outgoing  
messages), Prompt (to prompt you to choose Yes or No for every  
message), or DoNotSave (to save no message).  
DefaultCallback#: Select On (to add your callback number to all the  
outgoing messages) or Off. To enter or change the number, select  
Edit (right softkey). You may select on or off for an individual  
message (see “Message Options” on page 165).  
EntryMode: Select the text entry mode abc or T9 that first appears  
when entering a message.  
Signature: Select On (to enable adding your signature to the  
outgoing message) or Off. To edit the signature, select Edit (right  
softkey).  
DisplayFontSize: Select a font size Medium or Small for displaying  
text/picture/video messages.  
PresetMessages: Provides the messages that can be recalled when  
entering text messages. There are two types of preset messages:  
default and custom. You can view the default preset messages by  
selecting View (right softkey). You can edit or erase custom  
preset messages by highlighting an entry and selecting Edit (right  
softkey) or Erase (left softkey).  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Signing Up for Updates  
With Updates, you can have news and information sent directly to  
your PCS Phone at the times you choose.  
To select the information you want to send to your PCS Phone:  
1. From your computer, log on to the Internet.  
2. Go to the site from which you want to receive information. A  
®
®
®,  
few of the sites you can visit are America Online , Yahoo! , MSN  
®
and eBay . (The location where you request updates within  
each site will vary.)  
3. Where indicated on the site, input your 10-digit PCS Phone  
Number followed by “@messaging.sprintpcs.com.” For  
example: [email protected].  
Upon completing the registration process, you should begin  
receiving updates on your PCS Phone as requested.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
172  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PCS Mail  
Using PCS Mail  
With PCS Mail, you can perform many of the typical email functions  
from your PCS Phone that you can from your personal computer.  
You can manage your PCS Mail account from your PCS Phone or from  
your personal computer at www.sprintpcs.com. You can also access  
other select email providers from the Web through your PCS Mail.  
Accessing PCS Mail Messages  
To access PCS Mail messages:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Messaging and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Email and press  
. (If you’re a first-time user, your  
phone will prompt you to set up your PCS Mail account by  
establishing a User Name and password.)  
4. To view your messages, select Inbox.  
5. Scroll to select the message you wish to read and press the left  
softkey.  
6. Once you’ve read a message, use the quick actions at the end of  
each message (Reply, ReplyAll, Forward, Erase, and more).  
Composing PCS Mail Messages  
To compose a PCS Mail message:  
1. From the PCS Mail menu (see steps 1-3 above), select  
Compose.  
2. Select the box under To and enter the recipient's email address.  
3. Select the box under Subject: and enter the email subject.  
4. Select the box under Message:, enter your email message, and  
OK  
press  
.
OK  
5. Highlight Send and press  
to send the message.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PCS Short Mail  
Using PCS Short Mail  
With PCS Short Mail, you can use a person’s wireless phone number  
to send instant text messages from your PCS Vision Phone to their  
messaging-ready phone – and they can send messages to you. When  
you receive a new message, you’ll automatically be notified with a  
one-way text message.  
In addition, PCS Short Mail includes a variety of pre-set messages,  
such as “I’m running late, I’m on my way,that make composing  
messages fast and easy. You can also customize your own pre-set  
messages (up to 100 characters) from your PCS Phone.  
To send a PCS Short Mail message:  
1. Press the navigation key left (Web) to launch the Web.  
(The PCS Vision Home page will display.)  
2. Select Messaging.  
3. Select ShortMail.  
4. Select Compose.  
OK  
5. Select To and press  
recipient and press  
to display your Short List. Highlight a  
to add the recipient.  
OK  
– or –  
SelecttheboxafterTo, entertherecipient's10-digitmessaging-  
OK  
readywirelessphonenumber, andpress  
toaddtherecipient.  
Note: You must use the right softkey to select the 123 character input mode to  
enter the recipients phone number.  
6. Select Add (or add additional recipients and select Add).  
7. Compose a message or use the pre-set messages or icons.  
Totypeamessage, highlighttheMessage box, useyourkeypad  
OK  
totypeamessage, andpress  
whenyouarefinished. (Use  
therightsoftkeytoselectacharacterinputmode.)  
To use a pre-set message or “emoticon,” highlight Insert and  
select Pre-setMsgs or Icons. Select Go, then select the  
message or emoticon you’d like to insert and select OK.  
8. Review your message and select Send.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
174  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To read a PCS Short Mail message:  
1. When you receive a short mail, you will be notified by a message  
on the screen.  
2. Select Go (left softkey). The browser will launch.  
3. Scroll to the new short mail message and press the left softkey.  
Unread short mail messages will be marked with an asterisk (*).  
Note: The last four digits from the PCS Phone Number of the person who sent you  
a short mail message appear before the message text. If the sender is on your  
short list, their nickname will appear instead of their number.  
To reply to a PCS Short Mail message:  
1. While the message is open, select Reply.  
2. Compose your reply or use the pre-set messages or icons.  
To type a reply, highlight the Message box, use your keypad  
OK  
to type a message, and press  
when you are finished.  
(Use the right softkey to select a character input mode.)  
To use a pre-set message or “emoticon,” highlight Insert and  
select Pre-setMsgs or Icons. Select Go, then select the  
message or emoticon you’d like to insert and select OK.  
3. Review your reply and select Send.  
To add and/or edit Pre-Set Messages:  
1. Press the navigation key left (Web) to launch the Web.  
(The PCS Vision Home page will display.)  
2. Select Messaging.  
3. Select ShortMail.  
4. Select Settings.  
5. Select Pre-setMessages.  
6. From the Pre-set Messages menu, select (AddNew) or the  
message you wish to edit.  
7. Enter your new message or changes and select Save.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chat  
PCS Vision gives you the ability to join wireless chatrooms from your  
PCS Phone. Send text messages and icons to chatroom participants  
or launch a one-on-one (private) chatroom.  
To access a chatroom from the browser:  
1. Press the navigation key left (Web) to launch the Web.  
(The PCS Vision Home page will display.)  
2. Select Messaging.  
3. Select Chat.  
4. You will see a disclaimer for Wireless Chat. SelectAgree  
(left softkey) to enter the Chat menu.  
5. Select a chatroom from the menu (for example, “Friends”  
or “Singles”).  
OK  
6. Use your keypad to enter a nickname, press  
, and select  
Enter (left softkey). Once in the chatroom, you may scroll  
through the postings to read messages from other chatroom  
participants.  
Note: To avoid inadvertent data usage charges, you should log out of chatrooms  
when you are ready to exit.  
To post a message:  
1. Select Addtext.  
2. Enter your message.  
3. Select Send.  
To set up a private chatroom:  
1. During an active chat session, select 1->1.  
2. Select a chatter with whom you’d like to launch a private  
OK  
chatroom and press  
. (A message will be sent to the other  
party, inviting them to a 1-on-1 chat with you.)  
To exit a chatroom:  
Select LeaveRoom.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
176  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Downloading Premium Services Content  
With PCS Vision and your new PCS Vision Phone, you have access to a  
dynamic variety of Premium Service content such as downloadable  
Games, Ringers, and Screen Savers. While each type of download  
involves a different file type, the basic method for accessing and  
downloading files is the same.  
AccessingtheDownloadMenus  
To access the PCS Vision download menus:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Downloads and press  
.
Shortcut: You can also press the navigation key down ( ) from standby mode  
to access the Downloads menu.  
3. Select the type of file you wish to download (Games, Ringers,  
OK  
ScreenSavers, Applications, orOthers) and press  
.
OK  
4. Select GetNew and press  
. The browser will launch and  
take you to the corresponding download menu.  
To access the PCS Vision download menus from the Web browser:  
From the home page, select Downloads and then Games, Ringers,  
ScreenSavers, or Applications to go to the corresponding  
download menu. (For more information on navigating the Web,  
see “Navigating the Web” on page 156.)  
SelectinganItemtoDownload  
From the download menus, items available for download may be  
searched in a number of ways:  
Featured displays a rotating selection of featured items.  
BrowseCategory allows you to narrow your search to a general  
category, such as Movie/TV Themes for Ringers or College Logos  
for Screen Savers. (There may be several pages of available  
content in a list. Select Next9 to view additional items.)  
Search allows you to use your keypad to enter search criteria to  
locate an item. You may enter an entire word or title or perform a  
partial-word search (for example, entering “goo” returns “Good  
Ol’ Boy,The Good, the Bad, and the Ugly,and “Goofy - Club”).  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DownloadinganItem  
Once you’ve decided on an item to download, highlight it and  
OK  
press  
or select OK (left softkey). You will see a summary page for  
the item including its title, the vendor, the download detail, the file  
size, and the cost. Links allow you to view the LicenseDetails page,  
which outlines the price, license type, and length of license for the  
download, and the TermsofUse page, which details the Premium  
Services Terms of Use and your responsibility for payment.  
To download a selected item:  
1. From the information page, select Buy (or GetIt in the case of a  
free item). If you have not previously purchased an item, you  
will be prompted to create your purchasing profile.  
2. You will see a Confirmation screen confirming your purchase and  
informing you that the charge will be added to your next  
PCS Invoice. You will also be informed that the downloaded  
item has been stored in the MyContentManager page.  
3. Select Download to initiate the download of the item. (You  
will see a series of browser screens, ending with the Download  
screen, which lists the item name, vendor, version, size,  
and type.)  
4. Select Next (right softkey) to download the item.  
5. You will see another series of screens detailing the download  
initiation, progress (in kilobytes), and saving process. When the  
Complete screen appears, the item has been successfully  
downloaded to your phone.  
6. From the Complete screen, following several options are  
OK  
available. Highlight an option and press  
.
Use to view or play the downloaded item.  
Shop to look for other items to download.  
ContinueWeb to continue viewing the current Web page.  
Exit to quit the browser and return to standby mode.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
178  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Games  
You can play a variety of entertaining and graphically-rich games on  
your PCS Phone. New games are easy to download and play.  
Tip: For complete instructions on downloading, see Downloading Premium  
Services Contenton page 177.  
DownloadingGames  
To download a game to your phone:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Downloadsand press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Games and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight GetNew and press  
. The browser will launch and  
take you to the Games download menu.  
5. Use your navigation key to highlight and select a game you wish  
to download. (For more information on navigating the Web, see  
“Navigating the Web” on page 156.)  
6. From the item information page, select Buy. If you have not  
previously purchased an item, you will be prompted to create  
your purchasing profile.  
7. A confirmation page will notify you that the Game has been  
purchased and is stored in the MyContentManager folder. To  
download the game, select Download.  
8. From the Download screen, select Next (right softkey) to  
download the game. When the Completed screen appears, the  
game has been successfully downloaded to your phone.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PlayingGames  
To play a downloaded game on your PCS Phone:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Downloadsand press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Games and press  
. (The Games screen will display.)  
4. Highlight the game you wish to play and select Run (left softkey)  
OK  
or press  
.
5. If applicable, a prompt will display the days remaining  
on the game license and ask if you want to continue.  
Select Yes.  
6. Follow the onscreen instructions to play the game. When you  
END  
are finished, select Exit (or Quit) or press  
.
7. Youwillbepromptedtoconfirm. SelectYes toexitorNo tocancel.  
DownloadedGameOptions  
From the Games screen, select Options (right softkey) to display  
OK  
several options. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
NetworkAccess to select a network access option (AlwaysAllow,  
NeverAllow, or PromptInstance) for playing the game.  
Properties to display the game’s name, version, vendor, and more.  
OnlineInfo to view more information on the Web.  
Shop to download more games.  
Erase to erase the game.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
180  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ringers  
Tip: For complete instructions on downloading, see Downloading Premium  
Services Contenton page 177.  
DownloadingRingers  
To download an available ringer to your phone:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Downloadsand press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Ringers and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight GetNew and press  
. The browser will launch and  
take you to the Ringers download menu.  
5. Use your navigation key to highlight and select a ringer you  
wish to download. (For more information on navigating the  
Web, see “Navigating the Web” on page 156.)  
6. From the item information page, select Buy. If you have not  
previously purchased an item, you will be prompted to create  
your purchasing profile.  
7. A confirmation page will notify you that the ringer has been  
purchased and is stored in the MyContentManagerfolder. To  
download the ringer, select Download.  
8. From the Download screen, select Next (right softkey) to  
download the ringer. When the Completed screen appears, the  
ringer has been successfully downloaded to  
your phone.  
Note: You may store a limited number of downloaded ringers on your phone.  
Additional downloads will be stored in your personal vault.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AssigningDownloadedRingers  
Downloaded ringers may be assigned directly from the Downloads  
menu and are also available through the  
Settings menu.  
To assign a downloaded ringer through the Settings menu, see  
“Selecting Ringer Types for Voice Calls” on page 32 or “Selecting a  
Ringer Type for Text/Picture Messages” on page 34.  
To assign a downloaded ringer from the Downloads menu:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Downloadsand press  
.
OK  
3. HighlightRingers andpress  
. (TheRingersscreenwilldisplay.)  
OK  
OK  
4. Highlight a ringer and press  
to play the ringer. (Press  
to stop the playback.)  
5. Select Assign (left softkey).  
6. Highlight VoiceCalls, Voicemail, TextMsg/Pic. Mail, PhoneBook,  
OK  
or Time and press  
. The following three items require an  
extra step:  
VoiceCalls to select a call type (WithCallerID, Restricted, No  
CallerID, or Roaming).  
PhoneBook to select your desired entry and select a phone  
number or email address.  
Time to select an option (Alarm, Countdown, or Scheduler).  
Note: You may assign a ringer to more than one type of call.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
182  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DownloadedRingerOptions  
From the Ringers screen, select Options (right softkey) to display  
OK  
several options. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
SetRinger to assign the ringer to the phone tasks.  
Properties to display the ringer’s name, version, vendor, and more.  
OnlineInfo to view more information on the Web.  
Shop to download more ringers.  
Erase to erase the ringer.  
PurchasingRingers  
You can purchase ringers directly from your phone by following the  
instructions on page 178 or through www.sprintpcs.com  
Note: Your personal vault saves items for up to 90 days. Once an item has been  
downloaded to your phone, you may keep the file for as long as you like.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Screen Savers  
Tip: For complete instructions on downloading, see Downloading Premium  
Services Contenton page 177.  
DownloadingScreenSavers  
To download an available Screen Saver to your phone:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Downloadsand press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight ScreenSavers and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight GetNew and press  
. The browser will launch and  
take you to the Screen Savers download menu.  
5. Use your navigation key to highlight and select a Screen Saver  
you wish to download. (For more information on navigating the  
Web, see “Navigating the Web” on page 156.)  
6. From the item information page, select Buy. If you have not  
previously purchased an item, you will be prompted to create  
your purchasing profile.  
7. A confirmation page will notify you that the Screen Saver has  
been purchased and is stored in the MyContentManagerfolder.  
To download the Screen Saver, select Download.  
8. From the Download screen, select Next (right softkey) to  
download the Screen Saver. When the Completed screen  
appears, the Screen Saver has been successfully downloaded to  
your phone.  
Note: You may store a limited number of downloaded Screen Savers on your  
phone, depending on the file sizes. Additional downloads will be stored in your  
personal vault.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
184  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AssigningDownloadedScreenSavers  
Downloaded Screen Savers may be assigned directly from  
the Downloads menu and are also available through the  
Settings menu.  
To assign a downloaded Screen Saver through the Settings menu, see  
“Changing the Screen Saver” on page 40.  
To assign a downloaded Screen Saver from the Downloads menu:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Downloadsand press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight ScreenSavers and press  
. (The Screen Savers  
screen will display in thumbnail view.)  
OK  
Tip: To expand a Screen Saver, highlight it and press  
. Press the navigation  
BACK  
key left or right to scroll through Screen Savers in full-screen. Press  
return to thumbnail view.  
to  
4. Highlight a Screen Saver in thumbnail view and select Assign  
(left softkey).  
5. Highlight ScreenSaver, PhoneBook, Scheduler, SubLCD, Main  
OK  
Menu, or MyMenu and press  
. The following four items  
require an extra step:  
ScreenSaver to select a display mode  
(Always, Weekly, or SpecialDays).  
PhoneBook to select your desired entry.  
MainMenu to select a type of the Main Menu  
(ThumbnailView or ListView).  
MyMenu to select a type of the My Menu  
(Thumbnail Viewor ListView).  
Note: You may assign a Screen Saver to more than one task.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DownloadedScreenSaverOptions  
From the Screen Savers screen, select Options (right softkey) to display  
OK  
several options. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
SetImage to assign the Screen Saver to the phone tasks.  
Properties to display the Screen Saver’s name, version, vendor, and  
more.  
OnlineInfo to view more information on the Web.  
Shop to download more Screen Savers.  
Erase to erase the Screen Saver.  
ListVieworThumbnail Viewto switch the Screen Savers screen  
between the list and thumbnail view.  
PurchasingScreenSavers  
You can purchase Screen Savers directly from your phone by  
following the instructions on page 178, or through www.sprintpcs.com  
Note: Your personal vault saves items for up to 90 days. Once an item has been  
downloaded to your phone, you may keep the file for as long as you like.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
186  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Applications  
You can run a variety of applications on your PCS Phone. New  
applications are easy to download and run.  
Tip: For complete instructions on downloading, see Downloading Premium  
Services Contenton page 177.  
DownloadingApplications  
To download an available application:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Downloads and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Applications and press  
.
OK  
4. Highlight GetNew and press  
. The browser will launch and  
take you to the Applications download menu.  
RunningApplications  
To run a downloaded application on your PCS Phone:  
MENU  
1. Press  
to access the main menu.  
OK  
2. Highlight Downloads and press  
.
OK  
3. Highlight Applications and press  
. (The Applications screen  
will display.)  
4. Highlight the application you wish to run and select Run (left  
OK  
softkey) or press  
.
DownloadedApplicationOptions  
From the Applications screen, select Options (right softkey) to display  
OK  
several options. To select an option, highlight it and press  
.
NetworkAccess to select a network access option (AlwaysAllow,  
NeverAllow, or PromptInstance) for running the application.  
Properties to display the application’s name, version, vendor, and  
more.  
OnlineInfo to view more information on the Web.  
Shop to download more applications.  
Erase to erase the application.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Web  
With Web on your PCS Vision Phone, you can browse full-color  
graphic versions – not just text versions – of your favorite Websites,  
making it easier than ever to stay informed while on the go. Check  
sports scores, trade stocks, and shop on your PCS Phone anywhere  
within the enhanced Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.  
In addition to the features already covered in this section, the  
PCS Vision Home page offers always-on access to these colorful,  
graphically rich Web categories. Many sites are available under more  
than one menu – choose the one that's most convenient for you.  
News: Get up-to-the-minute news regarding finance, business,  
sports, and entertainment at sites like CNN, Bloomberg, USA  
Today, and Forbes.  
Weather: Access The Weather Channel to get current weather  
conditions and forecasts.  
Entertainment: Get the latest buzz on your favorite stars as well as  
movie and music reviews at Websites like E! Online, Pocket  
TM  
BoxOffice , and TastNtalk.  
Sports: Enjoy current news, statistics, and sports scores, as well as  
updates of events in progress at ESPN.com and other sports sites.  
Finance: Use Websites like Bloomberg, Fidelity, and Forbes to get  
stock quotes, make trades, and check your bank account online.  
Travel: Access flight information and make dining arrangements  
from travel Websites like Saber and Fodors.  
Shopping: Browse or purchase from popular shopping Websites  
like Amazon.com or Edmunds.  
Tools: Use tools like Switchboard to access yellow pages, white  
pages – even reverse phone number look-up or use Google to  
search for other Websites or images.  
BusinessLinks: Access your PCS Business Connection Personal or  
Enterprise Edition along with links to many business-related sites.  
MyAccount: Check minutes and PCS Vision usage, view your  
current invoice, or make a payment.  
GoogleSearch: Launch a Google search in one of three classes:  
PCS Web, Images, or Internet.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
188  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Browser Menu  
Navigating the Web from your phone using the PCS Vision Home  
Page is easy once you get the hang of it. For details on how to navigate  
the Web, select menu items, and more, see “Navigating the Web” on  
page 156.  
Although the PCS Vision Home Page offers a broad and convenient  
array of sites and services for you to browse, not all sites are  
represented, and certain functionality, such as going directly to Web  
sites and creating bookmarks is not available. For these and other  
functions, you will need to use the browser menu. The browser  
menu is a drop-down menu which offers additional functionality to  
expand your use of the Web on your PCS Phone.  
OpeningtheBrowserMenu  
The browser menu may be opened anytime you have an active Vision  
session, from any page you are viewing. To open the browser menu:  
Select Menu (right softkey).  
The browser menu appears in the following several tabs that are  
switched sequentially by pressing the navigation key left or right.  
Navigate to select from basic options (see below).  
Bookmarks to display the bookmarks you saved.  
History to display URLs that you visited recently.  
Tools to use useful tools for Web browsing.  
Options to select from special functions (if applicable).  
Input Textto select from T9, abc, 123, and more (if applicable).  
Image to select an option for images (if applicable).  
BrowserNavigateMenu  
Home: Returns the browser to the PCS Vision Home page.  
GoToURL: Allows you to navigate directly to a Website by entering  
its URL (Website address).  
Search: Launches a Google search.  
MarkPage: Allows you to bookmark the current Web page.  
Forward: Goes forward one page within the viewed pages.  
Reload: Reloads the current Web page.  
Advanced: Allows you to configure and manage your browser  
settings.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CreatingaBookmark  
Bookmarks allow you to store the address of your favorite Websites  
for easy access at a later time.  
To create a bookmark:  
1. Go to the Web page you want to mark.  
2. Access the browser menu by selecting Menu (right softkey).  
3. Press the navigation key left or right to display the Navigate menu.  
OK  
4. Highlight MarkPage and select Select (left softkey) or press  
.
(The bookmark title and URL are displayed.)  
OK  
5. Select Select (left softkey) or press  
to save the bookmark.  
Note: Bookmarking a page does not store the page contents, just  
its address.  
Note: Some pages cannot be bookmarked. Whether a particular Web page may  
be marked is controlled by its creator.  
AccessingaBookmark  
To access a bookmark:  
1. Access the browser menu by selecting Menu (right softkey).  
2. PressthenavigationkeyleftorrighttodisplaytheBookmarks menu.  
3. Highlight the bookmark you’d like to access and select Select  
OK  
(left softkey) or press  
to go to the Website.  
DeletingaBookmark  
1. Access the browser menu by selecting Menu (right softkey).  
2. PressthenavigationkeyleftorrighttodisplaytheBookmarks menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight More... and select Select (left softkey) or press  
.
4. Highlight the bookmark you’d like to delete and select Select  
OK  
(left softkey) or press  
.
5. Select Menu (right softkey) to display the Options menu.  
OK  
6. Highlight Delete and select Select (left softkey) or press  
.
(You will be prompted to confirm.)  
OK  
7. Select OK (left softkey) or press  
to delete the bookmark.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AssigningaHotkeyforaBookmark  
Hotkeys allow you to access your favorite Websites by pressing and  
holding digit keys (1 to 9).  
To assign a hotkey for a bookmark:  
1. Access the browser menu by selecting Menu (right softkey).  
2. PressthenavigationkeyleftorrighttodisplaytheBookmarks menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight More... and select Select (left softkey) or press  
.
4. Highlight the bookmark you'd like to assign a hotkey to and  
select Menu (right softkey) to display the Options menu.  
OK  
5. Highlight Hotkeys and select Select (left softkey) or press  
.
6. Highlight an empty entry (1 to 9) and select Assign (left softkey)  
OK  
or press  
to save it.  
To access a Website using a hotkey:  
During an active PCS Vision session, press and hold a digit key  
(1 to 9) to access the Website.  
GoingtoaSpecificWebsite  
To go to a particular Website by entering a URL (Website address):  
1. Access the browser menu by selecting Menu (right softkey).  
2. Press the navigation key left or right to display the Navigate menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight GoToURL and select Select (left softkey) or press  
.
4. Use your keypad to enter the URL of the Website you wish  
to go to.  
OK  
5. Select Done (left softkey) or press  
.
OK  
6. Select Select (left softkey) or press  
to go to the Website.  
Note: Not all Websites are viewable on your phone.  
ReloadingaWebPage  
To reload (refresh) a Web page:  
1. Access the browser menu by selecting Menu (right softkey).  
2. Press the navigation key left or right to display the Navigate menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight Reload and select Select (left softkey) or press  
.
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
RestartingtheWebBrowser  
If the Web browser appears to be malfunctioning or stops  
responding, you can usually fix the problem by simply restarting  
the browser.  
To restart your Web browser:  
1. Access the browser menu by selecting Menu (right softkey).  
2. Press the navigation key left or right to display the Navigate menu.  
OK  
3. Highlight Advanced and select Select (left softkey) or press  
.
4. Highlight RestartBrowser and select Select (left softkey)  
OK  
or press  
.
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
192  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SM  
PCS Business Connection  
Personal Edition  
SM  
PCS Business Connection Personal Edition gives you secure,  
®
®
®
real-time mobile access to your Microsoft Outlook or Lotus Notes  
company email, calendar, business directory, and personal contacts.  
You’ll have the features and functions of your Microsoft Outlook and  
Lotus Notes so you can view, create, reply to, and delete email;  
schedule appointments; and look up phone numbers in real time,  
anywhere on the enhanced Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.  
PCS Business Connection Personal Edition delivers the  
following features:  
Businessemailaccess: Read, reply to, forward, delete, and  
compose your company email.  
Companydirectoryandcontacts: Search, view, call, and email  
contacts from your company's directory. Do all this and add/edit  
your personal contacts.  
Workcalendar: Accept and decline meetings, view daily  
summaries and details, and navigate to various dates.  
Files/informationonyourPC: Browse folders, download, and  
view documents from any device using a PC browser or  
Pocket Internet Explorer.  
PCS Business Connection Personal Edition requires no hardware or  
software installation on your company’s network. Just install the  
PCS Business Connection Personal Edition software on your work  
PC. This allows data to be securely retrieved in real-time by your  
wireless device when connected to the enhanced Sprint Nationwide  
PCS Network. There is a monthly charge for PCS Business  
Connection and usage charges will also apply.  
When your work PC isn't on, you can share connections with your  
co-workers so that you always have access to your email, calendar,  
and contacts. Your data remains secure behind the corporate firewall  
and any changes you make on your wireless device are instantly  
updated on your company server without the need to synchronize.  
Additional PCS Business Connection solutions are available for your  
Note: See your PCS Service Plan for PCS Business Connection billing details.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PCS Vision FAQs  
HowwillIknowwhenmyphoneisreadyforPCSVisionservice?  
Your User Name (for example, [email protected]) will be found  
in your phone's main menu: Settings > Information > PhoneInfo.  
(When you have a PCS Vision connection.)  
HowdoIsign-inforthefirsttime?  
You are automatically signed in to access PCS Vision services when  
you turn on your phone.  
HowdoIknowwhenmyphoneisconnectedtoPCSVisionservices?  
Your phone automatically connects when PCS Vision service is used  
or an incoming message arrives. Your phone will also display the  
icon. (Connecting takes about 10-12 seconds.)  
CanImakecallsandusePCS Visionservicesatthesametime?  
You cannot use voice and PCS Vision services simultaneously.  
If you receive a call while PCS Vision service is active, the call will be  
forwarded to voicemail. You can place an outgoing call anytime, but  
it will interrupt any in-progress PCS Vision session.  
Whenismydataconnectionactive?  
Your connection is active when data is being transferred. Outgoing  
calls are allowed; incoming calls go directly to voicemail. When  
active, the  
indicator flashes on your phone’s display screen.  
Whenismydataconnectiondormant?  
If no data is received for 10 seconds, the connection goes dormant.  
When the connection is dormant, voice calls are allowed. (The  
connection may become active again quickly.) If no data is received  
for an extended period of time, the connection will terminate.  
CanIsignoutofdataservices?  
You can sign out without turning off your phone, however you will  
not be able to browse the Web or use other PCS Vision services.  
While signed out, you can still place or receive phone calls, check  
voicemail, and use other voice services. You may sign in again at any  
time. To sign out, go to Settings > PCSVision > DisablePCSVisionin  
your phone’s menu.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3B: PCS Vision  
194  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3C  
SM  
PCS Voice Command  
In This Section  
SM  
GettingStartedwithPCSVoiceCommand  
CreatingYourOwnAddressBook  
MakingaCallwithPCSVoiceCommand  
ith Sprint, the first wireless provider to offer innovative  
WPCS Voice Command technology, reaching your friends, family,  
and co-workers has never been easier – especially when you’re on the  
go. Your voice does it all with PCS Voice Command.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3C: PCS Voice Command  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting Started With PCS Voice Command  
With PCS Voice Command:  
You can store all your contacts’ phone numbers, so you can  
simply say the name of the person you want to call.  
There’s no need to punch in a lot of numbers, memorize  
voicemail passwords, or try to dial while you’re driving.  
You can call anyone in your address book – even if you don’t  
remember their phone number.  
It’sEasytoGetStarted  
TALK  
Just dial  
from your PCS Phone to activate the service  
and listen to brief instructions directly from your phone. There  
is a monthly charge for PCS Voice Command.  
Creating Your Own Address Book  
You can program up to 500 names into your personal address book,  
with each name having up to five phone numbers. That’s 2,500  
phone numbers – and with the advanced technology of PCS Voice  
Command – you can have instant access to all of them.  
There are four ways to update your address book:  
TALK  
UseVoiceRecordings: Simply dial  
and say, “Add name.”  
You will then be asked to say the name and number you want to  
add to your personal address book. Your address book can store  
up to 20 voice recorded names at once.  
OntheWeb: Go to www.talk.sprintpcs.com and receive a fully  
functional Web-based address book to create and update  
your contacts.  
UseanExistingAddressBook: Automatically merge address books  
SM  
from desktop software applications with Sprint Sync Services for  
no additional charge. Simply click on the “Click to synchronize”  
button within your PCS Voice Command personal address book  
CallDirectoryAssistance:If you don’t have a computer or Internet  
access handy, you can have PCS Directory Assistance look up  
phone numbers for you and automatically add them to your  
address book. Just say “Call operator” and we’ll add two names  
and numbers to your address book for our standard directory  
assistance charge.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3C: PCS Voice Command  
196  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Making a Call With PCS Voice Command  
To place a call using PCS Voice Command:  
1. Once you’ve signed up for PCS Voice Command and created  
TALK  
your address book, all you do is press  
. You’ll hear a  
tone followed by the prompt “Ready.”  
2. After the “Ready” prompt, simply say, in a natural voice,  
“Call” and the name of the person or the number you’d like to  
call. For example, you can say, Call Jane Smith at work,” “Call  
John Baker on the mobile phone,” “Call 555-1234,” or  
“Call Bob Miller.”  
3. Your request will be repeated and you will be asked to verify.  
Say “Yes” to call the number or person. Say “No” if you wish  
to cancel.  
4. The number will automatically be dialed. Keep in mind that  
PCS Voice Command recognizes not only your voice, but any  
voice, so that others can experience the same convenience if  
they use your phone.  
For more helpful hints on PCS Voice Command, including a list of  
recognized commands and an interactive tutorial, visit  
Note: PCS Voice Command is not available while roaming off the enhanced  
Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.  
Section 3: Using PCS Service Features  
3C: PCS Voice Command  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4  
Safety Guidelines and  
Warranty Information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4A  
Safety  
In This Section  
Getting the Most Out of Your Reception  
MaintainingSafeUseofandAccesstoYourPhone  
CaringfortheBattery  
Acknowledging Special Precautions and the FCC Notice  
Consumer Information on Wireless Phones  
art of getting the most out of your PCS Phone is learning how the  
Pphone works and how to care for it. This section outlines  
performance and safety guidelines that help you understand the basic  
features of your phone’s operation.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting the Most Out of Your Reception  
KeepingTabsonSignalStrength  
The quality of each call you make or receive depends on the signal  
strength in your area. Your phone informs you of the current signal  
strength by displaying a number of bars next to the signal strength  
icon. The more bars displayed, the stronger the signal. If you’re inside  
a building, being near a window may give you better reception.  
UnderstandingthePowerSaveFeature  
If your phone is unable to find a signal after 15 minutes of searching, a  
Power Save feature is automatically activated. If your phone is active, it  
periodically rechecks service availability or you can check it yourself  
by pressing any key. Anytime the Power Save feature is activated, a  
message displays on the screen. When a signal is found, your phone  
returns to standby mode.  
UnderstandingHowYourPhoneOperates  
Your phone is basically a radio transmitter and receiver. When it’s  
turned on, it receives and transmits radiofrequency (RF) signals.  
When you use your phone, the system handling your call controls the  
power level. This power can range from 0.01 µ watts to 0.2 watts in  
digital mode.  
KnowingRadiofrequencySafety  
The design of your PCS Phone complies with updated NCRP  
standards described below.  
In 1991-92, the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers  
(IEEE) and the American National Standards Institute (ANSI) joined in  
updating ANSI’s 1982 standard for safety levels with respect to  
human exposure to RF signals. More than 120 scientists, engineers  
and physicians from universities, government health agencies and  
industries developed this updated standard after reviewing the  
available body of research. In 1993, the Federal Communications  
Commission (FCC) adopted this updated standard in a regulation. In  
August 1996, the FCC adopted hybrid standard consisting of the  
existing ANSI/IEEE standard and the guidelines published by the  
National Council of Radiation Protection and Measurements (NCRP).  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MaintainingYourPhone’sPeakPerformance  
There are several simple guidelines to operating your phone properly  
and maintaining safe, satisfactory service.  
Hold the phone with the antenna raised, fully-extended, and over  
your shoulder.  
Try not to hold, bend, or twist the phone’s antenna.  
Don’t use the phone if the antenna is damaged.  
Speak directly into the mouthpiece.  
Avoid exposing your phone and accessories to rain or liquid  
spills. If your phone does get wet, immediately turn the power off  
and remove the battery. If it’s inoperable, return it to a Sprint  
SM  
Store or call PCS Customer Solutions for service.  
Note: For the best care of your phone, only Sprint authorized personnel should  
service your phone and accessories. Faulty service may void  
the warranty.  
Maintaining Safe Use of and Access to  
Your Phone  
FAILURE TO FOLLOW THE INSTRUCTIONS OUTLINED MAY LEAD  
TO SERIOUS PERSONAL INJURY AND POSSIBLE PROPERTY  
DAMAGE  
UsingYourPhoneWhileDriving  
Talking on your phone while driving (or operating the phone  
without a hands-free device) is prohibited in some jurisdictions.  
Laws vary as to specific restrictions. Remember that safety always  
comes first.  
When using your phone in the car:  
Get to know your phone and its features, such as speed dial  
and redial.  
When available, use a hands-free device.  
Position your phone within easy reach.  
Let the person you are speaking to know you are driving; if  
necessary, suspend the call in heavy traffic or hazardous  
weather conditions.  
Do not take notes or look up phone numbers while driving.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dial sensibly and assess the traffic; if possible, place calls when  
stationary or before pulling into traffic.  
Do not engage in stressful or emotional conversations that may  
divert your attention from the road.  
9
1
1
Dial  
to report serious emergencies. It’s free from  
your wireless phone.  
Use your phone to help others in emergencies.  
Call roadside assistance or a special non-emergency wireless  
number when necessary.  
Tip: Purchase an optional hands-free accessory at your local Sprint Store.  
You may also call the PCS Accessory Hotline at 1-800-974-2221 or by  
#
2
2
2
dialing  
on your PCS Phone.  
FollowingSafetyGuidelines  
To operate your phone safely and efficiently, always follow  
any special regulations in a given area. Turn your phone off in areas  
where use is forbidden or when it may cause interference or danger.  
UsingYourPhoneNearOtherElectronicDevices  
Most modern electronic equipment is shielded from radiofrequency  
(RF) signals. However, RF signals from wireless phones may affect  
inadequately shielded electronic equipment.  
RF signals may affect improperly installed or inadequately shielded  
electronic operating systems and/or entertainment systems in motor  
vehicles. Check with the manufacturer or their representative to  
determine if these systems are adequately shielded from external RF  
signals. Also check with the manufacturer regarding any equipment  
that has been added to your vehicle.  
Consult the manufacturer of any personal medical devices, such as  
pacemakers and hearing aids, to determine if they are adequately  
shielded from external RF signals.  
Note: Always turn off the phone in health care facilities and request permission  
before using the phone near medical equipment.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
202  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Pacemakers  
The Health Industry Manufacturers Association recommends that a  
minimum separation of six (6”) inches be maintained between a  
handheld wireless phone and a pacemaker to avoid potential  
interference with the pacemaker. These recommendations are  
consistent with the independent research by and recommendations  
of Wireless Technology Research.  
Persons with pacemakers:  
Should ALWAYS keep the phone more than six (6”) inches from  
their pacemaker when the phone is turned on.  
Should not carry the phone in a breast pocket.  
Should use the ear opposite the pacemaker to minimize the  
potential for interference.  
If you have any reason to suspect that interference is taking place,  
turn your phone off immediately.  
TurningOffYourPhoneBeforeFlying  
Turn off your phone before boarding any aircraft. To prevent possible  
interference with aircraft systems, the U.S. Federal Aviation  
Administration (FAA) regulations require you to have permission  
from a crew member to use your phone while the plane is on the  
ground. To prevent any risk of interference, FCC regulations prohibit  
using your phone while the plane is in the air.  
TurningOffYourPhoneinDangerousAreas  
To avoid interfering with blasting operations, turn off your phone  
when in a blasting area or in other areas with signs indicating that  
two-way radios should be turned off. Construction crews often use  
remote-control RF devices to set off explosives.  
Turn off your phone when you’re in any area that has a potentially  
explosive atmosphere. Although it’s rare, your phone or its  
accessories could generate sparks. Sparks could cause an explosion  
or a fire resulting in bodily injury or even death. These areas are  
often, but not always, clearly marked. They include:  
Fueling areas such as gas stations.  
Below deck on boats.  
Fuel or chemical transfer or storage facilities.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Areas where the air contains chemicals or particles such as grain,  
dust, or metal powders.  
Any other area where you would normally be advised to turn off  
your vehicle’s engine.  
Note: Never transport or store flammable gas, liquid, or explosives in the  
compartment of your vehicle that contains your phone or accessories.  
ForVehiclesEquippedwithanAirBag  
An air bag inflates with great force. DO NOT place objects, including  
either installed or portable wireless equipment, in the area over the  
air bag or in the air bag deployment area. If in-vehicle wireless  
equipment is improperly installed and the air bag inflates, serious  
injury could result.  
RestrictingChildren’sAccesstoyourPhone  
Your PCS Phone is not a toy. Children should not be allowed to play  
with it because they could hurt themselves and others, damage the  
phone or make calls that increase your phone bill.  
CaringforYourPhone  
Never attempt to disassemble the phone or any of its accessories.  
If service or repair is required, return the unit to a Sprint  
authorized service center. If the unit should be disassembled, a  
risk of electric shock or fire may result.  
Always use Sprint-approved accessories and optional devices  
when operating this cellular phone, as the use of incompatible  
auxiliary equipment could result in fire, electric shock or other  
bodily injury. The use of unauthorized accessories will also void  
your Warranty.  
When the phone is used for extended periods of time in high  
temperature conditions the phone surface could become hot.  
Please use caution when touching the phone under such  
conditions.  
Use in Vehicles - Always secure the phone in its holder, when it is  
not in use. Never place the phone on the passenger seat or  
anyplace else in the car where it can become a projectile during a  
collision or sudden stop.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
204  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Never expose this phone to high temperatures, such as those  
found near a heater or in a closed car parked in the sun. This can  
cause heat-damage to the plastic parts, the electronic  
components and the battery.  
Never drop this phone or subject it to violent impact or shock.  
This can cause mechanical damage.  
Never store this phone in cold areas. When the phone warms up  
(to its normal operating temperature), moisture can form inside  
the phone, which may damage the phone’s electronic circuit  
board.  
Never use harsh chemicals, cleaning solvents, or strong  
detergents to clean this phone. Always clean it with a soft cloth  
that has been slightly dampened in a mild soap-and-water  
solution.  
Never paint this phone. This can clog the moving parts.  
If you at anytime notice an allergic skin reaction from use of this  
product, immediately discontinue use and consult with your  
physician.  
Do not aim your camera at the sun. The sunlight passing through  
the camera lens may cause damage to the camera.  
Do not use your camera's flash close to a person's eyes. This may  
cause the person to lose eyesight temporarily and result in an  
accident.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Caring for the Battery  
ProtectingYourBattery  
The guidelines listed below help you get the most out of your  
battery’s performance.  
Use only Sprint-approved batteries and desktop chargers.  
These chargers are designed to maximize battery life. Using  
other batteries or chargers voids your warranty and may  
cause damage.  
In order to avoid damage, charge the battery only in temperatures  
that range from 32º F to 113º F (0º C to 45º C).  
Don’t use the battery charger in direct sunlight or in high  
humidity areas, such as the bathroom.  
Never dispose of the battery by incineration.  
Keep the metal contacts on top of the battery clean.  
Don’t attempt to disassemble or short-circuit the battery.  
The battery may need recharging if it has not been used for a long  
period of time.  
It’s best to replace the battery when it no longer provides  
acceptable performance. It can be recharged hundreds of times  
before it needs replacing.  
Don’t store the battery in high temperature areas for long periods  
of time. It’s best to follow these storage rules:  
Less than one month:  
-4º F to 140º F (-20º C to 60º C)  
More than one month:  
-4º F to 113º F (-20º C to 45º C)  
Never expose the terminals of the battery pack to any other metal  
object. Always wrap it or place it in a plastic bag, whenever  
transporting it.  
Never heat and never attempt to disassemble the battery pack, as  
that could cause leakage of the caustic electrolyte. If the battery is  
accidentally broken, avoid skin contact with the contents. In the  
event of skin contact, wash the affected area immediately and  
obtain prompt medical attention.  
Always turn your phone OFF before removing the battery pack,  
and always use the battery pack for its intended purpose only.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
206  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DisposalofLithiumIon(LiIon)Batteries  
For safe disposal options of your LiIon batteries, contact your nearest  
Sprint-authorized service center.  
SpecialNote:Be sure to dispose of your battery properly. In some  
areas, the disposal of batteries in household or business trash may  
be prohibited.  
Note:For safety, do not handle a damaged or leaking LiIon battery.  
Maintaining Safe Use of the Travel Charger  
The travel charger and the desktop charger that were designed for  
this unit both require the use of a standard 120 V AC power source for  
their operation.  
Never attempt to disassemble or repair a travel charger or desktop  
charger, as exposure to electric shock hazards may result. Always  
contact a Sprint authorized service center if repair or  
replacement is required.  
Never alter the AC cord or plug on your travel charger or desktop  
charger. If the plug will not fit into the available outlet, have a  
proper outlet installed by a qualified electrician. Improper  
connection can result in the risk of electric shock.  
Never allow any liquids or water to spill on the travel charger or  
desktop charger when it is connected to an AC power source.  
There is a risk of fire or electric shock.  
Always use the Sprint-approved travel charger or desktop charger  
to avoid any risk of fire or damage to your cellular phone or  
battery. Bodily injury or property damage may occur as a result of  
the use of an unauthorized and incompatible travel charger or  
desktop charger.  
Never use a travel charger or desktop charger if it has a damaged  
or worn power cord or plug. The use of damaged or worn power  
cords or plugs could result in electric shock, burns or fire.  
Contact a Sprint-authorized service center immediately to obtain  
a suitable replacement.  
Always unplug the travel charger or desktop charger from the  
power source before attempting any cleaning in order to avoid  
the risk of electric shock. Always use a soft cloth dampened with  
water to clean the equipment, after it has been unplugged.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Never attempt to use an unauthorized travel charger or desktop  
charger with your phone in order to avoid any risk of bodily injury  
or property damage. Since unauthorized accessories have different  
specifications, they may be incompatible with your phone.  
Always confirm that the power cord for any accessory is located  
so that it will not be stepped on, tripped over, or otherwise  
subjected to damage or stress.  
Never place heavy objects on a power cord, as this could result in  
damage to the cord.  
Never bend or twist a power cord, and never pull on a power  
cord in an attempt to remove a travel charger or accessory plug  
from a socket. Always grasp the travel charger or the accessory  
plug directly when unplugging the device in order to avoid  
damaging the cord.  
Always disconnect the travel charger or desktop charger from the  
power source when it is not in use.  
WARNING: Handling the cord on this product or cords associated  
with accessories sold with this product, will expose you to lead, a  
chemical known to the State of California to cause birth defects or  
other reproductive harm. Washhandsafterhandling.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
208  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Acknowledging Special Precautions  
and the FCC Notice  
FCC Notice  
The phone may cause TV or radio interference if used in close  
proximity to receiving equipment. The FCC can require you to stop  
using the phone if such interference cannot be eliminated.  
Vehicles using liquefied petroleum gas (such as propane or butane)  
must comply with the National Fire Protection Standard (NFPA-58).  
For a copy of this standard, contact the National Fire Protection  
Association, One Batterymarch Park, Quincy, MA 02269, Attn:  
Publication Sales Division.  
Cautions  
Any changes or modifications to your phone not expressly approved  
in this document could void your warranty for this equipment, and  
void your authority to operate this equipment. Only use approved  
batteries, antennas and chargers. The use of any unauthorized  
accessories may be dangerous and void the phone warranty if said  
accessories cause damage or a defect to the phone.  
Although your phone is quite sturdy, it is a complex piece of  
equipment and can be broken. Avoid dropping, hitting, bending or  
sitting on it.  
Body-WornOperation  
To maintain compliance with FCC RF exposure guidelines, if you  
wear a handset on your body, use the Sprint supplied or approved  
carrying case, holster or other body-worn accessory. If you do not  
use a body-worn accessory, ensure that the antenna is at least 0.6 inch  
(1.5 centimeters) from your body when transmitting. Use of non-  
Sprint approved accessories may violate FCC RF exposure guidelines.  
For more information about RF exposure, please visit the FCC Website  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SpecificAbsorptionRates(SAR)forWirelessPhones  
The SAR is a value that corresponds to the relative amount of RF  
energy absorbed in the head of a user of a wireless handset.  
The SAR value of a phone is the result of an extensive testing,  
measuring and calculation process. It does not represent how much  
RF the phone emits. All phone models are tested at their highest  
value in strict laboratory settings. But when in operation, the SAR of a  
phone can be substantially less than the level reported to the FCC.  
This is because of a variety of factors including its proximity to a base  
station antenna, phone design and other factors. What is important  
to remember is that each phone meets strict federal guidelines.  
Variations in SARs do not represent a variation in safety.  
All phones must meet the federal standard, which incorporates a  
substantial margin of safety. As stated above, variations in SAR values  
between different model phones do not mean variations in safety.  
SAR values at or below the federal standard of 1.6 W/kg are  
considered safe for use by the public.  
The highest reported SAR values of the VM4050 are:  
AMPS mode (Part 22) - Head:0.855 W/kg; Body-worn: 0.922 W/kg  
PCS mode (Part 24) - Head: 0.726 W/kg; Body-worn: 0.585 W/kg  
FCCRadiofrequencyEmission  
This phone meets the FCC Radiofrequency Exposure Guidelines.  
FCC ID number: CJ6DCFC009001. More information on the phone's  
SAR can be found from the following FCC Website:  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
210  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Emergency Calls  
Never rely solely upon your wireless phone for essential  
communications (e.g. medical emergencies), if it can be avoided,  
since a wireless phone requires a complex combination of radio  
signals, relay stations, and landline networks for its operation.  
Consequently, emergency calls may not always be possible under all  
conditions on all wireless phone systems.  
Your wireless phone, however, may sometimes be the only available  
means of communication at the scene of an accident. When making  
an emergency call, always give the recipient all necessary  
information as accurately as possible. Never terminate an emergency  
call until you have received clearance to do so.  
FCCEnhanced911(E911)RulesBackground  
The Federal Communications Commission (FCC) requires wireless  
carriers to transmit specific latitude and longitude location  
(Automatic Location Identification = ALI) information as well as  
“911” calls to Public Safety Answering Points (PSAPs) to identify the  
location of the caller in case of emergency. Accuracy requirement for  
ALI information by FCC E911 rules is within 50 meters for 67 percent  
of calls and within 150 meters for 95 percent of calls (FCC's ALI  
Requirements).  
YourPhone'sALICapability  
This phone is an ALI-capable phone equipped with the GPS (Global  
Positioning System: Satellite assisted location information system)  
receiver supporting GPS based ALI-capable network to comply with  
the FCC's ALI requirements.  
The network compliance with the above FCC requirements is  
dependent on: (a) the use of digital technology by the wireless  
network; (b) GPS satellite signals being able to reach the handset  
(such transmissions do not always work indoors, for example) ; and  
(c) handset signals reaching wireless “base stations” (atmospheric  
and environmental conditions may cause variations in handset  
receiving signal strength).  
Also, the transmission of the ALI information is subject, in part, to  
system constraints within the wireless network to which the E911  
signal is transmitted and over which Audiovox has no control.  
Finally, customers are advised that the phone's ALI capability is to be  
used for E911 purposes only.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Consumer Information on Wireless Phones  
(The following information comes from a consumer information  
Web site jointly sponsored by the U.S. Food and Drug Administration  
(FDA) and the Federal Communications Commission (FCC), entitled  
“Cell Phone Facts: Consumer Information on Wireless Phones.” The  
information reproduced herein is dated April 3, 2002. For further  
1. Whatisradiofrequencyenergy(RF)?  
Radiofrequency (RF) energy is another name for radio waves. It is one  
form of electromagnetic energy that makes up the electromagnetic  
spectrum. Some of the other forms of energy in the electromagnetic  
spectrum are gamma rays, x-rays and light. Electromagnetic energy  
(or electromagnetic radiation) consists of waves of electric and  
magnetic energy moving together (radiating) through space. The  
area where these waves are found is called an electromagnetic field.  
Radio waves are created due to the movement of electrical charges in  
antennas. As they are created, these waves radiate away from the  
antenna. All electromagnetic waves travel at the speed of light. The  
major differences between the different types of waves are the  
distances covered by one cycle of the wave and the number of waves  
that pass a certain point during a set time period. The wavelength is  
the distance covered by one cycle of a wave. The frequency is the  
number of waves passing a given point in one second. For any  
electromagnetic wave, the wavelength multiplied by the frequency  
equals the speed of light. The frequency of an RF signal is usually  
expressed in units called hertz (Hz). One Hz equals one wave per  
second. One kilohertz (kHz) equals one thousand waves per second,  
one megahertz (MHz) equals one million waves per second, and one  
gigahertz (GHz) equals one billion waves per second.  
RF energy includes waves with frequencies ranging from about 3000  
waves per second (3 kHz) to 300 billion waves per second (300 GHz).  
Microwaves are a subset of radio waves that have frequencies ranging  
from around 300 million waves per second (300 MHz) to three billion  
waves per second (3 GHz).  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
212  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Howisradiofrequencyenergyused?  
Probably the most important use of RF energy is for  
telecommunications. Radio and TV broadcasting, wireless phones,  
pagers, cordless phones, police and fire department radios, point-to-  
point links and satellite communications all rely on RF energy.  
Other uses of RF energy include microwave ovens, radar, industrial  
heaters and sealers, and medical treatments. RF energy, especially at  
microwave frequencies, can heat water. Since most food has a high  
water content, microwaves can cook food quickly. Radar relies on RF  
energy to track cars and airplanes as well as for military applications.  
Industrial heaters and sealers use RF energy to mold plastic materials,  
glue wood products, seal leather items such as shoes and  
pocketbooks, and process food. Medical uses of RF energy include  
pacemaker monitoring and programming.  
3. Howisradiofrequencyradiationmeasured?  
RF waves and RF fields have both electrical and magnetic  
components. It is often convenient to express the strength of the RF  
field in terms of each component. For example, the unit “volts per  
meter” (V/m) is used to measure the electric field strength, and the  
unit “amperes per meter” (A/m) is used to express the magnetic field  
strength. Another common way to characterize an RF field is by  
means of the power density. Power density is defined as power per  
unit area. For example, power density can be expressed in terms of  
milliwatts (one thousandth of a watt) per square centimeter  
(mW/cm2 or microwatts (one millionth of a watt) per square  
centimeter (µW/cm2).  
The quantity used to measure how much RF energy is actually  
absorbed by the body is called the Specific Absorption Rate or SAR.  
The SAR is a measure of the rate of absorption of RF energy. It is  
usually expressed in units of watts per kilogram (W/kg) or milliwatts  
per gram (mW/g).  
4. WhatbiologicaleffectscanbecausedbyRFenergy?  
The biological effects of radiofrequency energy should not be  
confused with the effects from other types of electromagnetic  
energy.  
Very high levels of electromagnetic energy, such as is found in X-rays  
and gamma rays can ionize biological tissues. Ionization is a process  
where electrons are stripped away from their normal locations in  
atoms and molecules. It can permanently damage biological tissues  
including DNA, the genetic material. Ionization only occurs with  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
very high levels of electromagnetic energy such as X-rays and gamma  
rays. Often the term radiation is used when discussing ionizing  
radiation (such as that associated with nuclear power plants).  
The energy levels associated with radiofrequency energy, including  
both radio waves and microwaves, are not great enough to cause the  
ionization of atoms and molecules. Therefore, RF energy is a type of  
non-ionizing radiation. Other types of non-ionizing radiation include  
visible light, infrared radiation (heat) and other forms of  
electromagnetic radiation with relatively low frequencies.  
Large amounts of RF energy can heat tissue. This can damage tissues  
and increase body temperatures. Two areas of the body, the eyes and  
the testes, are particularly vulnerable to RF heating because there is  
relatively little blood flow in them to carry away excess heat.  
The amount of RF radiation routinely encountered by the general  
public is too low to produce significant heating or increased body  
temperature. Still, some people have questions about the possible  
health effects of low levels of RF energy. It is generally agreed that  
further research is needed to determine what effects actually occur  
and whether they are dangerous to people. In the meantime,  
standards-setting organizations and government agencies are  
continuing to monitor the latest scientific findings to determine  
whether changes in safety limits are needed to protect human health.  
FDA, EPA and other US government agencies responsible for public  
health and safety have worked together and in connection with WHO  
to monitor developments and identify research needs related to RF  
biological effects.  
5. WhatlevelsofRFenergyareconsideredsafe?  
Various organizations and countries have developed standards for  
exposure to radiofrequency energy. These standards recommend  
safe levels of exposure for both the general public and for workers. In  
the United States, the FCC has used safety guidelines for RF  
environmental exposure since 1985.  
The FCC guidelines for human exposure to RF electromagnetic fields  
are derived from the recommendations of two expert organizations,  
the National Council on Radiation Protection and Measurements  
(NCRP) and the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers  
(IEEE). In both cases, the recommendations were developed by  
scientific and engineering experts drawn from industry, government,  
and academia after extensive reviews of the scientific literature  
related to the biological effects of RF energy.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
214  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Many countries in Europe and elsewhere use exposure guidelines  
developed by the International Commission on Non-Ionizing  
Radiation Protection (ICNIRP). The ICNIRP safety limits are generally  
similar to those of the NCRP and IEEE, with a few exceptions. For  
example, ICNIRP recommends different exposure levels in the lower  
and upper frequency ranges and for localized exposure from certain  
products such as hand-held wireless telephones. Currently, the  
World Health Organization is working to provide a framework for  
international harmonization of RF safety standards.  
The NCRP, IEEE, and ICNIRP all have identified a whole-body Specific  
Absorption Rate (SAR) value of 4 watts per kilogram (4 W/kg) as a  
threshold level of exposure at which harmful biological effects may  
occur. Exposure guidelines in terms of field strength, power density  
and localized SAR were then derived from this threshold value. In  
addition, the NCRP, IEEE, and ICNIRP guidelines vary depending on  
the frequency of the RF exposure. This is due to the finding that  
whole-body human absorption of RF energy varies with the  
frequency of the RF signal. The most restrictive limits on whole-body  
exposure are in the frequency range of 30-300 MHz where the human  
body absorbs RF energy most efficiently. For products that only  
expose part of the body, such as wireless phones, exposure limits in  
terms of SAR only are specified.  
The exposure limits used by the FCC are expressed in terms of SAR,  
electric and magnetic field strength, and power density for  
transmitters operating at frequencies from 300 kHz to 100 GHz. The  
specific values can be found in two FCC bulletins, OET Bulletins 56  
6. WhyhastheFCCadoptedguidelinesforRFexposure?  
The FCC authorizes and licenses products, transmitters, and facilities  
that generate RF and microwave radiation. It has jurisdiction over all  
transmitting services in the U.S. except those specifically operated by  
the Federal Government. While the FCC does not have the expertise  
to determine radiation exposure guidelines on its own, it does have  
the expertise and authority to recognize and adopt technically sound  
standards promulgated by other expert agencies and organizations,  
and has done so . (Our joint efforts with the FDA in developing this  
website is illustrative of the kind of inter-agency efforts and  
consultation we engage in regarding this health and safety issue.)  
Under the National Environmental Policy Act of 1969 (NEPA), the  
FCC has certain responsibilities to consider whether its actions will  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
significantly affect the quality of the human environment. Therefore,  
FCC approval and licensing of transmitters and facilities must be  
evaluated for significant impact on the environment. Human  
exposure to RF radiation emitted by FCC-regulated transmitters is  
one of several factors that must be considered in such environmental  
evaluations. In 1996, the FCC revised its guidelines for RF exposure  
as a result of a multi-year proceeding and as required by the  
Telecommunications Act of 1996.  
Radio and television broadcast stations, satellite-earth stations,  
experimental radio stations and certain wireless communication  
facilities are required to undergo routine evaluation for RF  
compliance when they submit an application to the FCC for  
construction or modification of a transmitting facility or renewal of a  
license. Failure to comply with the FCC's RF exposure guidelines  
could lead to the preparation of a formal Environmental Assessment,  
possible Environmental Impact Statement and eventual rejection of  
an application. Technical guidelines for evaluating compliance with  
the FCC RF safety requirements can be found in the FCC's OET  
Low-powered, intermittent, or inaccessible RF transmitters and  
facilities are normally excluded from the requirement for routine  
evaluation for RF exposure. These exclusions are based on standard  
calculations and measurement data indicating that a transmitting  
station or equipment operating under the conditions prescribed is  
unlikely to cause exposures in excess of the guidelines under normal  
conditions of use. Such exclusions are not exclusions from  
compliance, but, rather, exclusions from routine evaluation. The  
FCC's policies on RF exposure and categorical exclusion can be  
found in Section 1.1307(b) of the FCC's Rules and Regulations [(47  
CFR 1.1307(b)].  
7. HowcanIobtaintheSpecificAbsorptionRate(SAR)valueformy  
wirelessphone?  
The FCC requires that wireless phones sold in the United States  
demonstrate compliance with human exposure limits adopted by the  
FCC in 1996. The relative amount of RF energy absorbed in the head  
of a wireless telephone-user is given by the Specific Absorption Rate  
(SAR), as explained above. The FCC requires wireless phones to  
comply with a safety limit of 1.6 watts per kilogram (1.6 W/kg) in  
terms of SAR.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
216  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information on SAR for a specific phone model can be obtained for  
many recently manufactured phones using the FCC identification  
(ID) number for that model. The FCC ID number is usually printed  
somewhere on the case of the phone. Sometimes it may be necessary  
to remove the battery pack to find the number. Once you have the ID  
number, go to the following Web address: www.fcc.gov/oet/fccid. On  
this page, you will see instructions for entering the FCC ID number.  
Type the FCC ID number exactly as requested (the Grantee Code is  
the first three characters, the Equipment Product Code is the rest of  
the FCC ID number). Then click on “Start Search.” The “Grant of  
Equipment Authorization” for your telephone should appear. Read  
through the grant for the section on “SAR Compliance,”  
“Certification of Compliance with FCC Rules for RF Exposure” or  
similar language. This section should contain the value(s) for typical  
or maximum SAR for your phone.  
Phones and other products authorized since June 2, 2000, should  
have the maximum SAR levels noted directly on the “Grant of  
Equipment Authorization.” For phones and products authorized  
between about mid-1998 and June 2000, detailed information on SAR  
levels is typically found in the exhibits associated with the grant.  
Once a grant is accessed, the exhibits can be viewed by clicking on  
“View Exhibit.” Grants authorized prior to 1998 are not part of the  
electronic database but, rather, have been documented in the form of  
paper records.  
The FCC database does not list phones by model number. However,  
consumers may find SAR information from other sources as well.  
Some wireless phone manufacturers make SAR information available  
on their own Web sites. In addition, some non-government Web sites  
provide SARs for specific models of wireless phones. However, the  
FCC has not reviewed these sites and makes no guarantees of their  
accuracy. Finally, phones certified by the Cellular  
Telecommunications and Internet Association (CTIA) are required to  
provide SAR information to consumers in the instructional materials  
that come with the phones.  
8. Dohands-freekitsforwirelessphonesreducerisksfromexposureto  
RFemissions?  
Since there are no known risks from exposure to RF emissions from  
wireless phones, there is no reason to believe that hands-free kits  
reduce risks. Hands-free kits can be used with wireless phones for  
convenience and comfort. These systems reduce the absorption of  
RF energy in the head because the phone, which is the source of the  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
RF emissions, will not be placed against the head. On the other hand,  
if the phone is mounted against the waist or other part of the body  
during use, then that part of the body will absorb more RF energy.  
Wireless phones marketed in the U.S. are required to meet safety  
requirements regardless of whether they are used against the head or  
against the body. Either configuration should result in compliance  
with the safety limit.  
9. DowirelessphoneaccessoriesthatclaimtoshieldtheheadfromRF  
radiationwork?  
Since there are no known risks from exposure to RF emissions from  
wireless phones, there is no reason to believe that accessories that  
claim to shield the head from those emissions reduce risks. Some  
products that claim to shield the user from RF absorption use special  
phone cases, while others involve nothing more than a metallic  
accessory attached to the phone. Studies have shown that these  
products generally do not work as advertised. Unlike “hand-free”  
kits, these so-called “shields” may interfere with proper operation of  
the phone. The phone may be forced to boost its power to  
compensate, leading to an increase in RF absorption. In February  
2002, the Federal trade Commission (FTC) charged two companies  
that sold devices that claimed to protect wireless phone users from  
radiation with making false and unsubstantiated claims. According to  
FTC, these defendants lacked a reasonable basis to substantiate their  
claim.  
10. Whatarewirelesstelephonebasestations?  
Fixed antennas used for wireless telecommunications are referred to  
as cellular base stations, cell stations, PCS (“Personal  
Communications Service”) stations or telephone transmission  
towers. These base stations consist of antennas and electronic  
equipment. Because the antennas need to be high in the air,  
they are often located on towers, poles, water tanks, or rooftops.  
Typical heights for freestanding base station towers are  
50-200 feet.  
Some base stations use antennas that look like poles, 10 to 15 feet in  
length, that are referred to as “omni-directional” antennas. These  
types of antennas are usually found in rural areas. In urban and  
suburban areas, wireless providers now more commonly use panel  
or sector antennas for their base stations. These antennas consist of  
rectangular panels, about 1 by 4 feet in dimension. The antennas are  
usually arranged in three groups of three antennas each. One antenna  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
218  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
in each group is used to transmit signals to wireless phones, and the  
other two antennas in each group are used to receive signals from  
wireless phones.  
At any base station site, the amount of RF energy produced depends  
on the number of radio channels (transmitters) per antenna and the  
power of each transmitter. Typically, 21 channels per antenna sector  
are available. For a typical cell site using sector antennas, each of the  
three transmitting antennas could be connected to up to 21  
transmitters for a total of 63 transmitters. However, it is unlikely that  
all of the transmitters would be transmitting at the same time. When  
omni-directional antennas are used, a cellular base station could  
theoretically use up to 96 transmitters, but this would be very  
unusual, and, once again, it is unlikely that all transmitters would be  
in operation simultaneously. Base stations used for PCS  
communications generally require fewer transmitters than those  
used for cellular radio transmissions, since PCS carriers usually have a  
higher density of base station antenna sites.  
11. Arewirelesstelephonebasestationssafe?  
The electromagnetic RF signals transmitted from base station  
antennas stations travel toward the horizon in relatively narrow  
paths. For example, the radiation pattern for an antenna array  
mounted on a tower can be likened to a thin pancake centered  
around the antenna system. The individual pattern for a single array  
of sector antennas is wedge-shaped, like a piece of pie. As with all  
forms of electromagnetic energy, the power decreases rapidly as one  
moves away from the antenna. Therefore, RF exposure on the ground  
is much less than exposure very close to the antenna and in the path  
of the transmitted radio signal. In fact, ground-level exposure from  
such antennas is typically thousands of times less than the exposure  
levels recommended as safe by expert organizations. So exposure to  
nearby residents would be well within safety margins.  
Cellular and PCS base stations in the United States are required to  
comply with limits for exposure recommended by expert  
organizations and endorsed by government agencies responsible for  
health and safety. Measurements made near cellular and PCS base  
station antennas mounted on towers have confirmed that ground-  
level exposures are typically thousands of times less than the  
exposure limits adopted by the FCC. In fact, in order to be exposed to  
levels at or near the FCC limits for cellular or PCS frequencies an  
individual would essentially have to remain in the main transmitted  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
radio signal (at the height of the antenna) and within a few feet from  
the antenna. This is, of course, very unlikely to occur.  
When cellular and PCS antennas are mounted on rooftops, RF levels  
on that roof or on others near by would probably be greater than  
those typically encountered on the ground. However, exposure  
levels approaching or exceeding safety guidelines should be  
encountered only very close to or directly in front of the antennas. In  
addition, for sector-type antennas, typically used for such rooftop  
base stations, RF levels to the side and in back of these antennas are  
insignificant. General guidelines on antenna installations and  
circumstances that might give rise to a concern about an facility's  
conformance with FCC regulations can be found in A Local  
Government Official's Guide to Transmitting Antenna RF Emission  
Safety: Rules, Procedures, and Practical Guidance. This Guide can be  
12. Whoregulatesexposuretoradiationfrommicrowaveovens, television  
setsandcomputermonitors?  
The Food and Drug Administration is responsible for protecting the  
public from harmful radiation emissions from these consumer  
products.  
13. DoestheFCCroutinelymonitorradiofrequencyradiationfrom  
antennas?  
The FCC does not have the resources or the personnel to routinely  
monitor the emissions for all the thousands of transmitters that are  
subject to FCC jurisdiction. However, the FCC does have  
measurement instrumentation for evaluating RF levels in areas that  
may be accessible to the public or to workers. If there is evidence for  
potential non-compliance with FCC exposure guidelines for a FCC-  
regulated facility, staff from the FCC's Office of Engineering and  
Technology or the FCC Enforcement Bureau can conduct and  
investigation, and, if appropriate, perform actual measurements.  
Circumstances that could give rise to a concern about an facility's  
conformance with FCC regulations can be found in in A Local  
Government Official's Guide to Transmitting Antenna RF Emission  
Safety: Rules, Procedures, and Practical Guidance. This Guide can be  
accessed at: http://www.fcc.gov/oet/rfsafety. Potential exposure  
problems should be brought to the FCC's attention by contacting the  
FCC RF Safety Program at: 202-418-2464 or by e-mail: [email protected].  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14. DoestheFCCmaintainadatabasethatincludesinformationonthe  
locationandtechnicalparametersofallthetransmittingtowers  
itregulates?  
Each of the FCC Bureaus maintains its own licensing database system  
for the service(s) it regulates (e.g., television, cellular service,  
satellite earth stations). The FCC issues two types of licenses: site  
specific and market based. In the case of site specific licensed  
facilities, technical operating information is collected from the  
licensee as part of the licensing process. However, in the case of  
market based licensing (e.g., PCS, cellular), the licensee is granted  
the authority to operate a radio communications system in a  
geographic area using as many facilities as are required, and the  
licensee is not required to provide the FCC with specific location and  
operating parameters of these facilities.  
Information on site specific licensed facilities can be found the  
“General Menu Reports” (GenMen) at  
The various FCC Bureaus also publish on at least a weekly basis, bulk  
extracts of their licensing databases. Each licensing database has its  
own unique file structure. These extracts consist of multiple, very  
large files. The FCC's Office of Engineering and Technology (OET)  
maintains an index to these databases at  
various databases include frequency, state/county,  
latitude/longitude, call-sign and licensee name. For further  
information on the Commission's existing databases, you can contact  
Donald Campbell at [email protected] or 202-418-2405.  
15. CanlocalandstategovernmentalbodiesestablishlimitsforRF  
exposure?  
Although some local and state governments have enacted rules and  
regulations about human exposure to RF energy in the past, the  
Telecommunications Act of 1996 requires the Federal Government  
to control human exposure to RF emissions. In particular, Section  
704 of the Act states that, “No State or local government or  
instrumentality thereof may regulate the placement, construction,  
and modification of personal wireless service facilities on the basis of  
the environmental effects of radio frequency emissions to the extent  
that such facilities comply with the Commission's regulations  
concerning such emissions.” Further information on federal  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
authority and FCC policy is available in a fact sheet from the FCC's  
Wireless Telecommunications Bureau at www.fcc.gov/wtb.  
16. Dowirelessphonesposeahealthhazard?  
The available scientific evidence does not show that any health  
problems are associated with using wireless phones. There is no  
proof, however, that wireless phones are absolutely safe. Wireless  
phones emit low levels of radiofrequency energy (RF) in the  
microwave range while being used. They also emit very low levels of  
RF when in the stand-by mode. Whereas high levels of RF can  
produce health effects (by heating tissue), exposure to low level RF  
that does not produce heating effects causes no known adverse  
health effects. Many studies of low level RF exposures have not found  
any biological effects. Some studies have suggested that some  
biological effects may occur, but such findings have not been  
confirmed by additional research. In some cases, other researchers  
have had difficulty in reproducing those studies, or in determining  
the reasons for inconsistent results.  
17. WhatisFDA'sroleconcerningthesafetyofwirelessphones?  
Under the law, FDA does not review the safety of radiation-emitting  
consumer products such as wireless phones before they can be sold,  
as it does with new drugs or medical devices. However, the agency  
has authority to take action if wireless phones are shown to emit  
radiofrequency energy (RF) at a level that is hazardous to the user. In  
such a case, FDA could require the manufacturers of wireless phones  
to notify users of the health hazard and to repair, replace or recall the  
phones so that the hazard no longer exists.  
Although the existing scientific data do not justify FDA regulatory  
actions, FDA has urged the wireless phone industry to take a number  
of steps, including the following:  
Support needed research into possible biological effects of RF of  
the type emitted by wireless phones;  
Design wireless phones in a way that minimizes any RF exposure  
to the user that is not necessary for device function; and  
Cooperate in providing users of wireless phones with the best  
possible information on possible effects of wireless phone use on  
human health  
FDA belongs to an interagency working group of the federal agencies  
that have responsibility for different aspects of RF safety to ensure  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
222  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
coordinated efforts at the federal level. The following agencies  
belong to this working group:  
National Institute for Occupational Safety and Health  
Environmental Protection Agency  
Federal Communications Commission  
Occupational Safety and Health Administration  
National Telecommunications and Information Administration  
The National Institutes of Health participates in some interagency  
working group activities, as well.  
FDA shares regulatory responsibilities for wireless phones with the  
Federal Communications Commission (FCC). All phones that are sold  
in the United States must comply with FCC safety guidelines that limit  
RF exposure. FCC relies on FDA and other health agencies for safety  
questions about wireless phones.  
FCC also regulates the base stations that the wireless phone networks  
rely upon. While these base stations operate at higher power than do  
the wireless phones themselves, the RF exposures that people get  
from these base stations are typically thousands of times lower than  
those they can get from wireless phones. Base stations are thus not  
the primary subject of the safety questions discussed in this  
document.  
18. Whatkindsofphonesarethesubjectofthisupdate?  
The term “wireless phone” refers here to hand-held wireless phones  
with built-in antennas, often called “cell,” “mobile,” or “PCS” phones.  
These types of wireless phones can expose the user to measurable  
radiofrequency energy (RF) because of the short distance between  
the phone and the user’s head. These RF exposures are limited by  
Federal Communications Commission safety guidelines that were  
developed with the advice of FDA and other federal health and safety  
agencies. When the phone is located at greater distances from the  
user, the exposure to RF is drastically lower because a person's RF  
exposure decreases rapidly with increasing distance from the source.  
The so-called “cordless phones,” which have a base unit connected to  
the telephone wiring in a house, typically operate at far lower power  
levels, and thus produce RF exposures well within the FCC's  
compliance limits.  
19. Whataretheresultsoftheresearchdonealready?  
The research done thus far has produced conflicting results, and  
many studies have suffered from flaws in their research methods.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Animal experiments investigating the effects of radiofrequency  
energy (RF) exposures characteristic of wireless phones have yielded  
conflicting results that often cannot be repeated in other  
laboratories. A few animal studies, however, have suggested that low  
levels of RF could accelerate the development of cancer in laboratory  
animals. However, many of the studies that showed increased tumor  
development used animals that had been genetically engineered or  
treated with cancer-causing chemicals so as to be pre-disposed to  
develop cancer in the absence of RF exposure. Other studies  
exposed the animals to RF for up to 22 hours per day. These  
conditions are not similar to the conditions under which people use  
wireless phones, so we don’t know with certainty what the results of  
such studies mean for human health.  
Three large epidemiology studies have been published since  
December 2000. Between them, the studies investigated any  
possible association between the use of wireless phones and primary  
brain cancer, glioma, meningioma, or acoustic neuroma, tumors of  
the brain or salivary gland, leukemia, or other cancers. None of the  
studies demonstrated the existence of any harmful health effects  
from wireless phone RF exposures. However, none of the studies can  
answer questions about long-term exposures, since the average  
period of phone use in these studies was around three years.  
20. WhatresearchisneededtodecidewhetherRFexposurefromwireless  
phonesposesahealthrisk?  
A combination of laboratory studies and epidemiological studies of  
people actually using wireless phones would provide some of the  
data that are needed. Lifetime animal exposure studies could be  
completed in a few years. However, very large numbers of animals  
would be needed to provide reliable proof of a cancer promoting  
effect if one exists. Epidemiological studies can provide data that is  
directly applicable to human populations, but 10 or more years’  
follow-up may be needed to provide answers about some health  
effects, such as cancer. This is because the interval between the time  
of exposure to a cancer-causing agent and the time tumors develop –  
if they do – may be many, many years. The interpretation of  
epidemiological studies is hampered by difficulties in measuring  
actual RF exposure during day-to-day use of wireless phones. Many  
factors affect this measurement, such as the angle at which the phone  
is held, or which model of phone is used.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
224  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21. WhatisFDAdoingtofindoutmoreaboutthepossiblehealtheffectsof  
wirelessphoneRF?  
FDA is working with the U.S. National Toxicology Program and with  
groups of investigators around the world to ensure that high priority  
animal studies are conducted to address important questions about  
the effects of exposure to radiofrequency energy (RF).  
FDA has been a leading participant in the World Health Organization  
International Electromagnetic Fields (EMF) Project since its  
inception in 1996. An influential result of this work has been the  
development of a detailed agenda of research needs that has driven  
the establishment of new research programs around the world. The  
Project has also helped develop a series of public information  
documents on EMF issues.  
FDA and the Cellular Telecommunications & Internet Association  
(CTIA) have a formal Cooperative Research and Development  
Agreement (CRADA) to do research on wireless phone safety. FDA  
provides the scientific oversight, obtaining input from experts in  
government, industry, and academic organizations. CTIA-funded  
research is conducted through contracts to independent  
investigators. The initial research will include both laboratory studies  
and studies of wireless phone users. The CRADA will also include a  
broad assessment of additional research needs in the context of the  
latest research developments around the world.  
22. WhatstepscanItaketoreducemyexposuretoradiofrequencyenergy  
frommywirelessphone?  
If there is a risk from these products – and at this point we do not  
know that there is – it is probably very small. But if you are concerned  
about avoiding even potential risks, you can take a few simple steps  
to minimize your exposure to radiofrequency energy (RF). Since time  
is a key factor in how much exposure a person receives, reducing the  
amount of time spent using a wireless phone will reduce RF  
exposure.  
If you must conduct extended conversations by wireless phone  
every day, you could place more distance between your body and the  
source of the RF, since the exposure level drops off dramatically with  
distance. For example, you could use a headset and carry the wireless  
phone away from your body or use a wireless phone connected to a  
remote antenna  
Again, the scientific data do not demonstrate that wireless phones are  
harmful. But if you are concerned about the RF exposure from these  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
products, you can use measures like those described above to reduce  
your RF exposure from wireless phone use.  
23. Whataboutchildrenusingwirelessphones?  
The scientific evidence does not show a danger to users of wireless  
phones, including children and teenagers. If you want to take steps to  
lower exposure to radiofrequency energy (RF), the measures  
described above would apply to children and teenagers using  
wireless phones. Reducing the time of wireless phone use and  
increasing the distance between the user and the RF source will  
reduce RF exposure.  
Some groups sponsored by other national governments have advised  
that children be discouraged from using wireless phones at all. For  
example, the government in the United Kingdom distributed leaflets  
containing such a recommendation in December 2000. They noted  
that no evidence exists that using a wireless phone causes brain  
tumors or other ill effects. Their recommendation to limit wireless  
phone use by children was strictly precautionary; it was not based on  
scientific evidence that any health hazard exists.  
24. Whataboutwirelessphoneinterferencewithmedicalequipment?  
Radiofrequency energy (RF) from wireless phones can interact with  
some electronic devices. For this reason, FDA helped develop a  
detailed test method to measure electromagnetic interference (EMI)  
of implanted cardiac pacemakers and defibrillators from wireless  
telephones. This test method is now part of a standard sponsored by  
the Association for the Advancement of Medical instrumentation  
(AAMI). The final draft, a joint effort by FDA, medical device  
manufacturers, and many other groups, was completed in late 2000.  
This standard will allow manufacturers to ensure that cardiac  
pacemakers and defibrillators are safe from wireless phone EMI.  
FDA has tested hearing aids for interference from handheld wireless  
phones and helped develop a voluntary standard sponsored by the  
Institute of Electrical and Electronic Engineers (IEEE). This standard  
specifies test methods and performance requirements for hearing  
aids and wireless phones so that that no interference occurs when a  
person uses a “compatible” phone and a “compatible” hearing aid at  
the same time. This standard was approved by the IEEE in 2000.  
FDA continues to monitor the use of wireless phones for possible  
interactions with other medical devices. Should harmful interference  
be found to occur, FDA will conduct testing to assess the interference  
and work to resolve the problem.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
226  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
25. Whichotherfederalagencieshaveresponsibilitiesrelatedtopotential  
RFhealtheffects?  
Certain agencies in the Federal Government have been involved in  
monitoring, researching or regulating issues related to human  
exposure to RF radiation. These agencies include the Food and Drug  
Administration (FDA), the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA),  
the Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA), the  
National Institute for Occupational Safety and Health (NIOSH), the  
National Telecommunications and Information Administration  
(NTIA) and the Department of Defense (DOD).  
By authority of the Radiation Control for Health and Safety Act of  
1968, the Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) of the  
FDA develops performance standards for the emission of radiation  
from electronic products including X-ray equipment, other medical  
devices, television sets, microwave ovens, laser products and  
sunlamps. The CDRH established a product performance standard  
for microwave ovens in 1971 limiting the amount of RF leakage from  
ovens. However, the CDRH has not adopted performance standards  
for other RF-emitting products. The FDA is, however, the lead federal  
health agency in monitoring the latest research developments and  
advising other agencies with respect to the safety of RF-emitting  
products used by the public, such as cellular and PCS phones.  
The FDA's microwave oven standard is an emission standard (as  
opposed to an exposure standard) that allows specific levels of  
microwave leakage (measured at five centimeters from the oven  
surface). The standard also requires ovens to have two independent  
interlock systems that prevent the oven from generating microwaves  
the moment that the latch is released or the door of the oven is  
opened. The FDA has stated that ovens that meet its standards and are  
used according to the manufacturer's recommendations are safe for  
consumer and industrial use. More information is available from:  
The EPA has, in the past, considered developing federal guidelines for  
public exposure to RF radiation. However, EPA activities related to RF  
safety and health are presently limited to advisory functions. For  
example, the EPA now chairs an Inter-agency Radiofrequency  
Working Group, which coordinates RF health-related activities  
among the various federal agencies with health or regulatory  
responsibilities in this area.  
OSHA is responsible for protecting workers from exposure to  
hazardous chemical and physical agents. In 1971, OSHA issued a  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
protection guide for exposure of workers to RF radiation [29 CFR  
1910.97]. However, this guide was later ruled to be only advisory and  
not mandatory. Moreover, it was based on an earlier RF exposure  
standard that has now been revised. At the present time, OSHA uses  
the IEEE and/or FCC exposure guidelines for enforcement purposes  
under OSHA's “general duty clause” (for more information see:  
NIOSH is part of the U.S. Department of Health and Human Services.  
It conducts research and investigations into issues related to  
occupational exposure to chemical and physical agents. NIOSH has,  
in the past, undertaken to develop RF exposure guidelines for  
workers, but final guidelines were never adopted by the agency.  
NIOSH conducts safety-related RF studies through its Physical Agents  
Effects Branch in Cincinnati,Ohio.  
The NTIA is an agency of the U.S. Department of Commerce and is  
responsible for authorizing Federal Government use of the RF  
electromagnetic spectrum. Like the FCC, the NTIA also has NEPA  
responsibilities and has considered adopting guidelines for  
evaluating RF exposure from U.S. Government transmitters such as  
radar and military facilities.  
The Department of Defense (DOD) has conducted research on the  
biological effects of RF energy for a number of years. This research is  
now conducted primarily at the U.S. Air Force Research Laboratory  
located at Brooks Air Force Base, Texas. The DOD Web site for RF  
biological effects information is listed with other sites in conjunction  
with a question on other sources of information, below.  
26. Whofundsandcarriesoutresearchonthebiologicaleffectsof  
RFenergy?  
Research into possible biological effects of RF energy is carried out in  
laboratories in the United States and around the world. In the U.S.,  
most research has been funded by the Department of Defense, due to  
the extensive military use of RF equipment such as radar and high-  
powered radio transmitters. In addition, some federal agencies  
responsible for health and safety, such as the Environmental  
Protection Agency (EPA) and the U.S. Food and Drug Administration  
(FDA), have sponsored and conducted research in this area. At the  
present time, most of the non-military research on biological effects  
of RF energy in the U.S. is being funded by industry organizations.  
More research is being carried out overseas, particularly in Europe.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
228  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In 1996, the World Health Organization (WHO) established the  
International EMF Project to review the scientific literature and work  
towards resolution of health concerns over the use of RF technology.  
WHO maintains a Web site that provides extensive information on  
this project and about RF biological effects and research  
FDA, EPA and other US government agencies responsible for public  
health and safety have worked together and in connection with WHO  
to monitor developments and identify research needs related to RF  
biological effects.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Owner’s Record  
The model number, regulatory number and serial number are located  
on a nameplate inside the battery compartment. Record the serial  
number in the space provided below. This will be helpful if you need  
to contact us about your phone in the future.  
Model: PCS Phone VM4050  
Serial No.:  
User’s Guide Proprietary Notice  
CDMA Technology is licensed by QUALCOMM Incorporated under  
one or more of the following patents:  
4,901,307 5,109,390 5,267,262 5,416,797  
5,506,865 5,544,196 5,657,420 5,101,501  
5,267,261 5,414,796 5,504,773 5,535,239  
5,600,754 5,778,338 5,228,054 5,337,338  
5,710,784 5,056,109 5,568,483 5,659,569  
5,490,165 5,511,073  
T9 Text Input is licensed by Tegic Communications and is covered by  
U.S. Pat. 5,818,437, U.S. Pat. 5,953,541, U.S. Pat. 6,011,554, U.S. Pat.  
6,307,548 and other patents pending.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
230  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
End User License Agreement  
This wireless device (“Device”) contains software owned by third  
parties (“Software”). Each recipient (“User”) of this Device is granted  
a non-exclusive, non-transferable, non-assignable license to use the  
Software solely in conjunction with the Device on which it is  
installed, for the duration of the useful life of such Device. Nothing  
herein shall be construed as the sale of the Software to the User of  
this Device. User shall not reproduce, modify, distribute, reverse  
engineer, decompile or otherwise discover the source code of the  
Software or any component of the Software. Each third party owner  
is the sole and exclusive owner of and retains all rights, title and  
interest in and to its Software. Each such third party shall be an  
intended third party beneficiary of these terms.  
THE SOFTWARE IS LICENSED TO YOU “AS IS. ANY AND ALL  
WARRANTIES REGARDING THE SOFTWARE, WHETHER EXPRESS  
OR IMPLIED, ARE HEREBY DISCLAIMED, INCLUDING WITHOUT  
LIMITATION THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF NON-INFRINGEMENT  
OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS, MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR  
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THERE IS NO WARRANTY THAT THE  
OPERATION OF THE SOFTWARE WILL BE UNINTERRUPTED OR  
ERROR FREE. SOME JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW THE  
EXCLUSION OF IMPLIED WARRANTIES, SO THE ABOVE  
EXCLUSION MAY NOT APPLY OR MAY BE LIMITED.  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4A: Safety  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4B  
Manufacturer’s Warranty  
In This Section  
Manufacturer’sWarranty  
his section contains the manufacturer’s warranty for your  
TPCS Phone.  
For information about the Terms and Conditions of your PCS Service,  
please see the Start Here guide included with your phone. For the  
most recent version of the Terms and Conditions, please visit  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4B:Warranty  
232  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manufacturer’s Warranty  
12MONTHLIMITEDWARRANTY  
Audiovox Communications Corp. (the Company) warrants to the  
original retail purchaser of this Audiovox handheld portable cellular  
telephone, that should this product or any part thereof during normal  
consumer usage and conditions, be proven defective in material or  
workmanship that results in product failure within the first twelve (12)  
month period from the date of purchase, such defect(s) will be repaired  
or replaced (with new or rebuilt parts) at the Company’s option, without  
charge for parts or labor directly related to the defect(s).  
The antenna, keypad, display, rechargeable battery and battery charger, if  
included, are similarly warranted for twelve (12) months from date of  
purchase.  
This Warranty extends only to consumers who purchase the product in  
the United States or Canada and it is not transferable or assignable.  
This Warranty does not apply to:  
(a) Product subjected to abnormal use or conditions, accident,  
mishandling, neglect, unauthorized alteration, misuse, improper  
installation or repair or improper storage;  
(b) Product whose mechanical serial number or electronic serial number  
has been removed, altered or defaced.  
(c) Damage from exposure to moisture, humidity, excessive  
temperatures or extreme environmental conditions;  
(d) Damage resulting from connection to, or use of any accessory or  
other product not approved or authorized by the Company;  
(e) Defects in appearance, cosmetic, decorative or structural items such  
as framing and non-operative parts;  
(f) Product damaged from external causes such as fire, flooding, dirt,  
sand, weather conditions, battery leakage, blown fuse, theft or  
improper usage of any electrical source.  
The Company disclaims liability for removal or reinstallation of the  
product, for geographic coverage, for inadequate signal reception by the  
antenna or for communications range or operation of the cellular system  
as a whole.  
To obtain repairs or replacement within the terms of this Warranty, the  
product should be delivered with proof of Warranty coverage (e.g. dated  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4B:Warranty  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
bill of sale), the consumer’s return address, daytime phone number  
and/or fax number and complete description of the problem,  
transportation prepaid, to the Company at the address shown below or to  
the place of purchase for repair or replacement processing. In addition,  
for reference to an authorized Warranty station in your area, you may  
telephone in the United States (800) 229-1235, and in Canada (800) 465-  
9672 (in Ontario call 905-712-9299).  
THE EXTENT OF THE COMPANY’S LIABILITY UNDER THIS WARRANTY  
IS LIMITED TO THE REPAIR OR REPLACEMENT PROVIDED ABOVE AND,  
IN NO EVENT, SHALL THE COMPANY’S LIABILITY EXCEED THE  
PURCHASE PRICE PAID BY PURCHASER FOR THE PRODUCT.  
ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING ANY IMPLIED WARRANTY  
OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  
SHALL BE LIMITED TO THE DURATION OF THIS WRITTEN WARRANTY.  
ANY ACTION FOR BREACH OF ANY WARRANTY MUST BE BROUGHT  
WITHIN A PERIOD OF 18 MONTHS FROM DATE OF ORIGINAL  
PURCHASE. IN NO CASE SHALL THE COMPANY BE LIABLE FOR ANY  
SPECIAL CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES FOR BREACH  
OF THIS OR ANY OTHER WARRANTY, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,  
WHATSOEVER. THE COMPANY SHALL NOT BE LIABLE FOR THE DELAY  
IN RENDERING SERVICE UNDER THIS WARRANTY OR LOSS OF USE  
DURING THE TIME THE PRODUCT IS BEING REPAIRED OR REPLACED.  
No person or representative is authorized to assume for the Company any  
liability other than expressed herein in connection with the sale of this  
product.  
Some states or provinces do not allow limitations on how long an implied  
warranty lasts or the exclusion or limitation of incidental or  
consequential damage so the above limitation or exclusions may not  
apply to you. This Warranty gives you specific legal rights, and you may  
also have other rights which vary from state to state or province to  
province.  
IN USA:  
AUDIOVOX COMMUNICATIONS CORP.  
555 Wireless Blvd.  
Hauppauge, NY 11788  
(800) 229-1235  
IN CANADA: AUDIOVOX COMMUNICATIONS CANADA CO.  
5155 Spectrum Way, Unit #5  
Mississauga, Ontario L4W 5A1  
(800) 465-9672  
Section 4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information  
4B:Warranty  
234  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Powered by JBlend®  
,
©1997-2003 Aplix Corporation. All rights reserved. Java and all Java-based trademarks and  
logos are trademarks or registered trademarks of Sun Microsystems, Inc. in the U.S. and other countries. JBlend and  
all JBlend-based trademarks and logos are trademarks or registered trademarks of Aplix Corporation in Japan and  
other countries.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Consumer Information on  
Wireless Phones 212-229  
Count Down Timer 98  
Index  
Numerics  
3-Way Calling 149  
911 18  
D
Desktop Charger 14  
Display Direction 44  
Display Screen Icons 10  
Display Settings 37-44  
A
Abbreviated Dialing 25, 49  
Airplane Mode 45  
Alarm Clock 97  
Alert Notification 36  
Answering Calls 17  
Any Key Answer 47  
Auto Answer 48  
E
Email See PCS Mail  
Emergency Numbers 18  
Entering Text 26  
Extended Absence Greeting 146  
B
F
Backlight 37-38  
Battery  
Finding Internal Phone Book  
Entries 77  
Capacity 13  
Charging 14  
Installing 13  
Removing 14  
Browser Menu 189  
G
Games 179  
Greeting 37  
Group List 89  
H
C
Help 4  
Calculator 99  
Call Forwarding 150  
Call Guard 61  
Call History 70-73  
Erasing 73  
Making a Call From 72  
Options 71  
Saving a Number From 72  
Viewing 71  
Call Waiting 148  
Caller ID 148  
Camcorder  
Camcorder Mode 117  
Taking Videos 116  
Camera  
Camera Mode 113  
Taking Pictures 110  
Chat 176  
I
Internal Phone Book  
Adding a Number 79  
Adding an Entry 76  
Dialing From 24  
Editing 80  
Erasing 85  
Finding an Entry 77  
Secret Entries 83  
Introduction ii  
K
Key Tone Length 34  
L
Language 48  
Location Settings 44  
Lock Code 54  
Lock Mode 54  
Locking Your Phone 53  
Clock Display 42  
Index  
236  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
Phone (illus.) 8  
Making Calls 16  
Manufacturers Warranty 232  
Menus 62-69  
Diagram 65-67  
My 68-69  
Navigation 63  
Structure 63  
Phone Book Match Dialing 49,86  
Phone Features 11  
Phone Information 51  
Phone Number  
Dialing With Pauses 23  
Displaying 16  
Finding 23  
Messaging 163  
PCS Mail 173  
Updates 172  
Saving 22  
Picture Mail 158 See also Camera  
Password 158  
Picture Mail Website 162  
Sharing Picture/Video Mail 158  
Missed Call Notification 18  
N
Net Guard 154  
R
Resetting Your Phone 56  
Ringer Types 31  
Roaming 57-61  
Analog Networks 59  
Call Guard 61  
O
Open to Answer 47  
P
PCS Business Connection 193  
PCS Callback 144  
PCS Mail 173  
Digital Networks 58  
Roam Mode 60  
PCS Services  
S
Call Forwarding 150  
Call Waiting 148  
Caller ID 148  
Customer Solutions 5  
Dialing 86  
Directory Assistance 5  
Operator Services 5  
PCS Vision  
Bookmarks 190-191  
Chat 176  
Downloading Applications 187  
FAQs 194  
Games 179  
Messaging 163  
Ringers 181  
Screen Savers 184  
User Name 152  
PCS Voice Command 195-197  
Personal Organizer 92-99  
Safety 199-231  
Saving a Phone Number 22  
Scheduler 93  
Adding an Event 93  
Erasing Events 95  
Event Alerts 94  
Options 94  
Screen Savers 184  
Security Menu 53  
Security Settings 52-56  
Setup Options 47-51  
Silence 36  
Sound Settings 31  
Special Numbers 55  
Speed Dialing 24, 48, 87  
Storing Pictures 124  
Storing Videos 130  
Index  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
T
Taking Pictures 110  
Taking Videos 116  
Three-Way Calling 149  
TTY Use 45  
Turning Your Phone Off 12  
Turning Your Phone On 12  
U
Unlocking Your Phone 3, 53  
Updates 172  
V
Vision Home Page 153  
Voice Memos 105-108  
Voice-Activated Dialing 101  
Voice Guidance 50  
Voicemail  
Clearing the Icon 146  
Expert Mode 144  
Menu 147  
Message Alerts 142  
Notification 142  
Options 144  
Retrieving 143  
Setting Up 4, 142  
Volume Settings 35  
W
Warranty 232  
Web  
Browsing 189  
Launching 153  
Index  
238  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

The Singing Machine Electronic Keyboard SMI 1420 User Manual
Toshiba Projector TLP X11U User Manual
Toshiba Security Camera IK TF7P2 User Manual
Toshiba Security Camera IPSe32 X User Manual
U Line Refrigerator CLR2160 STAINLESS User Manual
Ultra Products Power Supply ULT33062 User Manual
Univex Printer E120n User Manual
VDO Dayton Car Video System DOM 6500 User Manual
Watlow Electric Electric Heater Stock Heater User Manual
Weber Griddle 55556 User Manual